1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
5 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
6 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
8 This file is part of GCC.
10 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
11 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
12 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
15 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
16 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
17 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
20 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
22 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
24 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
25 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
26 out locations for types and decls.
27 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
28 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
30 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
31 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
32 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
33 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
36 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
38 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
39 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
40 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
41 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
42 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
44 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
45 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
47 CIE = Common Information Entry
48 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
50 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
52 FDE = Frame Description Entry
53 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
54 how to restore registers
56 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
57 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
61 #include "coretypes.h"
68 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
70 #include "insn-config.h"
78 #include "dwarf2out.h"
79 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
85 #include "diagnostic.h"
88 #include "langhooks.h"
93 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
94 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *);
97 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
98 # ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
99 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO \
100 (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
102 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO 0
106 /* Map register numbers held in the call frame info that gcc has
107 collected using DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM to those that should be output in
108 .debug_frame and .eh_frame. */
109 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT
110 #define DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT(REGNO, FOR_EH) (REGNO)
113 /* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
117 dwarf2out_do_frame (void)
119 /* We want to emit correct CFA location expressions or lists, so we
120 have to return true if we're going to output debug info, even if
121 we're not going to output frame or unwind info. */
122 return (write_symbols
== DWARF2_DEBUG
123 || write_symbols
== VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
125 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
126 || (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
127 && (flag_unwind_tables
128 || (flag_exceptions
&& ! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS
)))
133 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
135 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
138 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
139 must be kept around forever. */
140 static GTY(()) VEC(rtx
,gc
) *used_rtx_array
;
142 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
143 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
144 VEC(tree,gc) because we want to tell the garbage collector about
146 static GTY(()) VEC(tree
,gc
) *incomplete_types
;
148 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
149 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
150 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
151 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
152 define type declaration DIE's. */
153 static GTY(()) VEC(tree
,gc
) *decl_scope_table
;
155 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
156 static GTY(()) section
*debug_info_section
;
157 static GTY(()) section
*debug_abbrev_section
;
158 static GTY(()) section
*debug_aranges_section
;
159 static GTY(()) section
*debug_macinfo_section
;
160 static GTY(()) section
*debug_line_section
;
161 static GTY(()) section
*debug_loc_section
;
162 static GTY(()) section
*debug_pubnames_section
;
163 static GTY(()) section
*debug_pubtypes_section
;
164 static GTY(()) section
*debug_str_section
;
165 static GTY(()) section
*debug_ranges_section
;
166 static GTY(()) section
*debug_frame_section
;
168 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
169 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
170 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
173 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct
*dw_cfi_ref
;
174 typedef struct dw_fde_struct
*dw_fde_ref
;
175 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct
*dw_cfi_oprnd_ref
;
177 /* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
178 Information instructions. The register number, offset
179 and address fields are provided as possible operands;
180 their use is selected by the opcode field. */
182 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
{
184 dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num
,
190 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct
GTY(())
192 unsigned int GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num"))) dw_cfi_reg_num
;
193 HOST_WIDE_INT
GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_offset"))) dw_cfi_offset
;
194 const char * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_addr"))) dw_cfi_addr
;
195 struct dw_loc_descr_struct
* GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_loc"))) dw_cfi_loc
;
199 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct
GTY(())
201 dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next
;
202 enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc
;
203 dw_cfi_oprnd
GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
205 dw_cfi_oprnd
GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
210 /* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
211 as REG + OFFSET all the time, but now it can be more complex.
212 It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
213 Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
214 of this structure. */
215 typedef struct cfa_loc
GTY(())
217 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
;
218 HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset
;
220 int indirect
; /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference. */
223 /* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
224 refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
225 the beginning of the .debug_frame section. This use of a single
226 CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
227 in the DWARF generation routines below. */
229 typedef struct dw_fde_struct
GTY(())
232 const char *dw_fde_begin
;
233 const char *dw_fde_current_label
;
234 const char *dw_fde_end
;
235 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_label
;
236 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_end_label
;
237 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_label
;
238 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label
;
239 bool dw_fde_switched_sections
;
240 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi
;
241 unsigned funcdef_number
;
242 unsigned all_throwers_are_sibcalls
: 1;
243 unsigned nothrow
: 1;
244 unsigned uses_eh_lsda
: 1;
248 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
249 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
251 /* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
252 Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
253 but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses. On such machines,
254 Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
256 #ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
257 #define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
260 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
261 relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
262 DWARF-2 specification. The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
265 #ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
266 #define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
269 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
270 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
271 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
274 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
275 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
277 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
278 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
281 #define DWARF_VERSION 2
283 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
284 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
285 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
287 /* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor. */
288 #ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
289 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
290 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
292 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
296 /* CIE identifier. */
297 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
298 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
299 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
301 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
304 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
305 information for each routine. */
306 static GTY((length ("fde_table_allocated"))) dw_fde_ref fde_table
;
308 /* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table. */
309 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_allocated
;
311 /* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use. */
312 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_in_use
;
314 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
316 #define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
318 /* A list of call frame insns for the CIE. */
319 static GTY(()) dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head
;
321 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
322 /* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
323 attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
324 with the subprogram. This variable holds the table index of the FDE
325 associated with the current function (body) definition. */
326 static unsigned current_funcdef_fde
;
329 struct indirect_string_node
GTY(())
332 unsigned int refcount
;
337 static GTY ((param_is (struct indirect_string_node
))) htab_t debug_str_hash
;
339 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter
;
340 static GTY(()) unsigned long dwarf2out_cfi_label_num
;
342 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
343 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections
= false;
345 /* Whether the default text and cold text sections have been used at all. */
347 static GTY(()) bool text_section_used
= false;
348 static GTY(()) bool cold_text_section_used
= false;
350 /* The default cold text section. */
351 static GTY(()) section
*cold_text_section
;
353 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
355 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
357 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
358 static const char *dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned);
359 static dw_cfi_ref
new_cfi (void);
360 static void add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref
*, dw_cfi_ref
);
361 static void add_fde_cfi (const char *, dw_cfi_ref
);
362 static void lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref
, dw_cfa_location
*);
363 static void lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location
*);
364 static void reg_save (const char *, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT
);
365 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
366 static void initial_return_save (rtx
);
368 static HOST_WIDE_INT
stack_adjust_offset (const_rtx
);
369 static void output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref
, dw_fde_ref
, int);
370 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
371 static void dwarf2out_note_section_used (void);
372 static void dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx
, bool);
373 static void flush_queued_reg_saves (void);
374 static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save (const_rtx
);
375 static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx
, const char *);
377 /* Support for complex CFA locations. */
378 static void output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref
);
379 static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location
*,
380 struct dw_loc_descr_struct
*);
381 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct
*build_cfa_loc
382 (dw_cfa_location
*, HOST_WIDE_INT
);
383 static void def_cfa_1 (const char *, dw_cfa_location
*);
385 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
386 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
387 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
390 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
391 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
392 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
394 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
395 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
398 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
399 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
402 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
403 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
406 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
407 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
409 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
410 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
411 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
412 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
413 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
414 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
415 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
416 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
417 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
418 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
420 /* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address. Normally this
421 is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
423 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
425 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
427 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
431 /* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number. By
432 default, we just provide columns for all registers. */
433 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
434 #define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
437 /* Hook used by __throw. */
440 expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column (void)
442 unsigned int dwarf_regnum
= DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
);
443 return GEN_INT (DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (dwarf_regnum
, 1));
446 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
447 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
450 stripattributes (const char *s
)
452 char *stripped
= XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s
) + 2);
457 while (*s
&& *s
!= ',')
464 /* MEM is a memory reference for the register size table, each element of
465 which has mode MODE. Initialize column C as a return address column. */
468 init_return_column_size (enum machine_mode mode
, rtx mem
, unsigned int c
)
470 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
= c
* GET_MODE_SIZE (mode
);
471 HOST_WIDE_INT size
= GET_MODE_SIZE (Pmode
);
472 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem
, mode
, offset
), GEN_INT (size
));
475 /* Generate code to initialize the register size table. */
478 expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (tree address
)
481 enum machine_mode mode
= TYPE_MODE (char_type_node
);
482 rtx addr
= expand_normal (address
);
483 rtx mem
= gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode
, addr
);
484 bool wrote_return_column
= false;
486 for (i
= 0; i
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
; i
++)
488 int rnum
= DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i
), 1);
490 if (rnum
< DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
)
492 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
= rnum
* GET_MODE_SIZE (mode
);
493 enum machine_mode save_mode
= reg_raw_mode
[i
];
496 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i
, save_mode
))
497 save_mode
= choose_hard_reg_mode (i
, 1, true);
498 if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i
) == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
)
500 if (save_mode
== VOIDmode
)
502 wrote_return_column
= true;
504 size
= GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode
);
508 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem
, mode
, offset
),
509 gen_int_mode (size
, mode
));
513 if (!wrote_return_column
)
514 init_return_column_size (mode
, mem
, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
);
516 #ifdef DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
517 init_return_column_size (mode
, mem
, DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
);
520 targetm
.init_dwarf_reg_sizes_extra (address
);
523 /* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
526 dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned int cfi_opc
)
530 case DW_CFA_advance_loc
:
531 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
533 return "DW_CFA_offset";
535 return "DW_CFA_restore";
539 return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
540 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1
:
541 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
542 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2
:
543 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
544 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4
:
545 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
546 case DW_CFA_offset_extended
:
547 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
548 case DW_CFA_restore_extended
:
549 return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
550 case DW_CFA_undefined
:
551 return "DW_CFA_undefined";
552 case DW_CFA_same_value
:
553 return "DW_CFA_same_value";
554 case DW_CFA_register
:
555 return "DW_CFA_register";
556 case DW_CFA_remember_state
:
557 return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
558 case DW_CFA_restore_state
:
559 return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
561 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
562 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register
:
563 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
564 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset
:
565 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
568 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression
:
569 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
570 case DW_CFA_expression
:
571 return "DW_CFA_expression";
572 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf
:
573 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
574 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf
:
575 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
576 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf
:
577 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
579 /* SGI/MIPS specific */
580 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8
:
581 return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
584 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save
:
585 return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
586 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size
:
587 return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
588 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended
:
589 return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
592 return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
596 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction. */
598 static inline dw_cfi_ref
601 dw_cfi_ref cfi
= ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_cfi_node
));
603 cfi
->dw_cfi_next
= NULL
;
604 cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_reg_num
= 0;
605 cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd2
.dw_cfi_reg_num
= 0;
610 /* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions. */
613 add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref
*list_head
, dw_cfi_ref cfi
)
617 /* Find the end of the chain. */
618 for (p
= list_head
; (*p
) != NULL
; p
= &(*p
)->dw_cfi_next
)
624 /* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to. */
627 dwarf2out_cfi_label (void)
629 static char label
[20];
631 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label
, "LCFI", dwarf2out_cfi_label_num
++);
632 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, label
);
636 /* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
637 or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL. */
640 add_fde_cfi (const char *label
, dw_cfi_ref cfi
)
644 dw_fde_ref fde
= &fde_table
[fde_table_in_use
- 1];
647 label
= dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
649 if (fde
->dw_fde_current_label
== NULL
650 || strcmp (label
, fde
->dw_fde_current_label
) != 0)
654 label
= xstrdup (label
);
656 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
658 /* If we have a current label, advance from there, otherwise
659 set the location directly using set_loc. */
660 xcfi
->dw_cfi_opc
= fde
->dw_fde_current_label
661 ? DW_CFA_advance_loc4
663 xcfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_addr
= label
;
664 add_cfi (&fde
->dw_fde_cfi
, xcfi
);
666 fde
->dw_fde_current_label
= label
;
669 add_cfi (&fde
->dw_fde_cfi
, cfi
);
673 add_cfi (&cie_cfi_head
, cfi
);
676 /* Subroutine of lookup_cfa. */
679 lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref cfi
, dw_cfa_location
*loc
)
681 switch (cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
)
683 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset
:
684 loc
->offset
= cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_offset
;
686 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf
:
688 = cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_offset
* DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
;
690 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register
:
691 loc
->reg
= cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_reg_num
;
694 loc
->reg
= cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_reg_num
;
695 loc
->offset
= cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd2
.dw_cfi_offset
;
697 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf
:
698 loc
->reg
= cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_reg_num
;
700 = cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd2
.dw_cfi_offset
* DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
;
702 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression
:
703 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc
, cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_loc
);
710 /* Find the previous value for the CFA. */
713 lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location
*loc
)
717 loc
->reg
= INVALID_REGNUM
;
720 loc
->base_offset
= 0;
722 for (cfi
= cie_cfi_head
; cfi
; cfi
= cfi
->dw_cfi_next
)
723 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi
, loc
);
725 if (fde_table_in_use
)
727 dw_fde_ref fde
= &fde_table
[fde_table_in_use
- 1];
728 for (cfi
= fde
->dw_fde_cfi
; cfi
; cfi
= cfi
->dw_cfi_next
)
729 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi
, loc
);
733 /* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address. */
734 static dw_cfa_location cfa
;
736 /* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
738 static dw_cfa_location cfa_store
;
740 /* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack. */
741 static HOST_WIDE_INT args_size
;
743 /* The last args_size we actually output. */
744 static HOST_WIDE_INT old_args_size
;
746 /* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
747 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi. The value of CFA is now to be
748 calculated from REG+OFFSET. */
751 dwarf2out_def_cfa (const char *label
, unsigned int reg
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
)
758 def_cfa_1 (label
, &loc
);
761 /* Determine if two dw_cfa_location structures define the same data. */
764 cfa_equal_p (const dw_cfa_location
*loc1
, const dw_cfa_location
*loc2
)
766 return (loc1
->reg
== loc2
->reg
767 && loc1
->offset
== loc2
->offset
768 && loc1
->indirect
== loc2
->indirect
769 && (loc1
->indirect
== 0
770 || loc1
->base_offset
== loc2
->base_offset
));
773 /* This routine does the actual work. The CFA is now calculated from
774 the dw_cfa_location structure. */
777 def_cfa_1 (const char *label
, dw_cfa_location
*loc_p
)
780 dw_cfa_location old_cfa
, loc
;
785 if (cfa_store
.reg
== loc
.reg
&& loc
.indirect
== 0)
786 cfa_store
.offset
= loc
.offset
;
788 loc
.reg
= DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc
.reg
);
789 lookup_cfa (&old_cfa
);
791 /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions. */
792 if (cfa_equal_p (&loc
, &old_cfa
))
797 if (loc
.reg
== old_cfa
.reg
&& !loc
.indirect
)
799 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction, indicating
800 the CFA register did not change but the offset did. */
803 HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset
= loc
.offset
/ DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
;
804 gcc_assert (f_offset
* DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
== loc
.offset
);
806 cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
= DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf
;
807 cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_offset
= f_offset
;
811 cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
= DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset
;
812 cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_offset
= loc
.offset
;
816 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset. */
817 else if (loc
.offset
== old_cfa
.offset
818 && old_cfa
.reg
!= INVALID_REGNUM
821 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
822 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
823 offset has not changed. */
824 cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
= DW_CFA_def_cfa_register
;
825 cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_reg_num
= loc
.reg
;
829 else if (loc
.indirect
== 0)
831 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
832 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
833 the specified offset. */
836 HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset
= loc
.offset
/ DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
;
837 gcc_assert (f_offset
* DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
== loc
.offset
);
839 cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
= DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf
;
840 cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_reg_num
= loc
.reg
;
841 cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd2
.dw_cfi_offset
= f_offset
;
845 cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
= DW_CFA_def_cfa
;
846 cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_reg_num
= loc
.reg
;
847 cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd2
.dw_cfi_offset
= loc
.offset
;
852 /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
853 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
854 register-offset pair is available. */
855 struct dw_loc_descr_struct
*loc_list
;
857 cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
= DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression
;
858 loc_list
= build_cfa_loc (&loc
, 0);
859 cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_loc
= loc_list
;
862 add_fde_cfi (label
, cfi
);
865 /* Add the CFI for saving a register. REG is the CFA column number.
866 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
867 If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
868 otherwise it is saved in SREG. */
871 reg_save (const char *label
, unsigned int reg
, unsigned int sreg
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
)
873 dw_cfi_ref cfi
= new_cfi ();
875 cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_reg_num
= reg
;
877 if (sreg
== INVALID_REGNUM
)
880 /* The register number won't fit in 6 bits, so we have to use
882 cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
= DW_CFA_offset_extended
;
884 cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
= DW_CFA_offset
;
886 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
888 /* If we get an offset that is not a multiple of
889 DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, there is either a bug in the
890 definition of DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, or a bug in the machine
892 HOST_WIDE_INT check_offset
= offset
/ DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
;
894 gcc_assert (check_offset
* DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
== offset
);
897 offset
/= DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
;
899 cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
= DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf
;
901 cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd2
.dw_cfi_offset
= offset
;
903 else if (sreg
== reg
)
904 cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
= DW_CFA_same_value
;
907 cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
= DW_CFA_register
;
908 cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd2
.dw_cfi_reg_num
= sreg
;
911 add_fde_cfi (label
, cfi
);
914 /* Add the CFI for saving a register window. LABEL is passed to reg_save.
915 This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
916 from the previous frame's window save area.
918 ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
919 assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window. */
922 dwarf2out_window_save (const char *label
)
924 dw_cfi_ref cfi
= new_cfi ();
926 cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
= DW_CFA_GNU_window_save
;
927 add_fde_cfi (label
, cfi
);
930 /* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
931 pushed onto the stack. */
934 dwarf2out_args_size (const char *label
, HOST_WIDE_INT size
)
938 if (size
== old_args_size
)
941 old_args_size
= size
;
944 cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
= DW_CFA_GNU_args_size
;
945 cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_offset
= size
;
946 add_fde_cfi (label
, cfi
);
949 /* Entry point for saving a register to the stack. REG is the GCC register
950 number. LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
953 dwarf2out_reg_save (const char *label
, unsigned int reg
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
)
955 reg_save (label
, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg
), INVALID_REGNUM
, offset
);
958 /* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
959 LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
962 dwarf2out_return_save (const char *label
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
)
964 reg_save (label
, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
, INVALID_REGNUM
, offset
);
967 /* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
968 LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save. */
971 dwarf2out_return_reg (const char *label
, unsigned int sreg
)
973 reg_save (label
, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (sreg
), 0);
976 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
977 /* Record the initial position of the return address. RTL is
978 INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
981 initial_return_save (rtx rtl
)
983 unsigned int reg
= INVALID_REGNUM
;
984 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
= 0;
986 switch (GET_CODE (rtl
))
989 /* RA is in a register. */
990 reg
= DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl
));
994 /* RA is on the stack. */
996 switch (GET_CODE (rtl
))
999 gcc_assert (REGNO (rtl
) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
);
1004 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl
, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
);
1005 offset
= INTVAL (XEXP (rtl
, 1));
1009 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl
, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
);
1010 offset
= -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl
, 1));
1020 /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
1021 actually load. For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
1022 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames. */
1023 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl
, 1)) == CONST_INT
);
1024 initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl
, 0));
1031 if (reg
!= DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
)
1032 reg_save (NULL
, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
, reg
, offset
- cfa
.offset
);
1036 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
1039 static HOST_WIDE_INT
1040 stack_adjust_offset (const_rtx pattern
)
1042 const_rtx src
= SET_SRC (pattern
);
1043 const_rtx dest
= SET_DEST (pattern
);
1044 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
= 0;
1047 if (dest
== stack_pointer_rtx
)
1049 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
1050 code
= GET_CODE (src
);
1051 if (! (code
== PLUS
|| code
== MINUS
)
1052 || XEXP (src
, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
1053 || GET_CODE (XEXP (src
, 1)) != CONST_INT
)
1056 offset
= INTVAL (XEXP (src
, 1));
1060 else if (MEM_P (dest
))
1062 /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
1063 src
= XEXP (dest
, 0);
1064 code
= GET_CODE (src
);
1070 if (XEXP (src
, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx
)
1072 rtx val
= XEXP (XEXP (src
, 1), 1);
1073 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
1074 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (src
, 1)) == PLUS
1075 && GET_CODE (val
) == CONST_INT
);
1076 offset
= -INTVAL (val
);
1083 if (XEXP (src
, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx
)
1085 offset
= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest
));
1092 if (XEXP (src
, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx
)
1094 offset
= -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest
));
1109 /* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
1110 make a note of it if it does. EH uses this information to find out how
1111 much extra space it needs to pop off the stack. */
1114 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx insn
, bool after_p
)
1116 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
;
1120 /* Don't handle epilogues at all. Certainly it would be wrong to do so
1121 with this function. Proper support would require all frame-related
1122 insns to be marked, and to be able to handle saving state around
1123 epilogues textually in the middle of the function. */
1124 if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn
) || sibcall_epilogue_contains (insn
))
1127 /* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
1128 save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN. */
1129 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables
&& cfa
.reg
!= STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
)
1131 if (CALL_P (insn
) && !after_p
)
1133 /* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself. */
1134 insn
= PATTERN (insn
);
1135 if (GET_CODE (insn
) == PARALLEL
)
1136 insn
= XVECEXP (insn
, 0, 0);
1137 if (GET_CODE (insn
) == SET
)
1138 insn
= SET_SRC (insn
);
1139 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn
) == CALL
);
1140 dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn
, 1)));
1145 if (CALL_P (insn
) && !after_p
)
1147 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables
)
1148 dwarf2out_args_size ("", args_size
);
1151 else if (BARRIER_P (insn
))
1153 /* When we see a BARRIER, we know to reset args_size to 0. Usually
1154 the compiler will have already emitted a stack adjustment, but
1155 doesn't bother for calls to noreturn functions. */
1156 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1157 offset
= -args_size
;
1162 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn
)) == SET
)
1163 offset
= stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn
));
1164 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn
)) == PARALLEL
1165 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn
)) == SEQUENCE
)
1167 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1169 for (offset
= 0, i
= XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn
), 0) - 1; i
>= 0; i
--)
1170 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn
), 0, i
)) == SET
)
1171 offset
+= stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn
), 0, i
));
1179 if (cfa
.reg
== STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
)
1180 cfa
.offset
+= offset
;
1182 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1186 args_size
+= offset
;
1190 label
= dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1191 def_cfa_1 (label
, &cfa
);
1192 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables
)
1193 dwarf2out_args_size (label
, args_size
);
1198 /* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1199 of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered. This clusters
1200 register saves so that there are fewer pc advances. */
1202 struct queued_reg_save
GTY(())
1204 struct queued_reg_save
*next
;
1206 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_offset
;
1210 static GTY(()) struct queued_reg_save
*queued_reg_saves
;
1212 /* The caller's ORIG_REG is saved in SAVED_IN_REG. */
1213 struct reg_saved_in_data
GTY(()) {
1218 /* A list of registers saved in other registers.
1219 The list intentionally has a small maximum capacity of 4; if your
1220 port needs more than that, you might consider implementing a
1221 more efficient data structure. */
1222 static GTY(()) struct reg_saved_in_data regs_saved_in_regs
[4];
1223 static GTY(()) size_t num_regs_saved_in_regs
;
1225 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1226 static const char *last_reg_save_label
;
1228 /* Add an entry to QUEUED_REG_SAVES saying that REG is now saved at
1229 SREG, or if SREG is NULL then it is saved at OFFSET to the CFA. */
1232 queue_reg_save (const char *label
, rtx reg
, rtx sreg
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
)
1234 struct queued_reg_save
*q
;
1236 /* Duplicates waste space, but it's also necessary to remove them
1237 for correctness, since the queue gets output in reverse
1239 for (q
= queued_reg_saves
; q
!= NULL
; q
= q
->next
)
1240 if (REGNO (q
->reg
) == REGNO (reg
))
1245 q
= ggc_alloc (sizeof (*q
));
1246 q
->next
= queued_reg_saves
;
1247 queued_reg_saves
= q
;
1251 q
->cfa_offset
= offset
;
1252 q
->saved_reg
= sreg
;
1254 last_reg_save_label
= label
;
1257 /* Output all the entries in QUEUED_REG_SAVES. */
1260 flush_queued_reg_saves (void)
1262 struct queued_reg_save
*q
;
1264 for (q
= queued_reg_saves
; q
; q
= q
->next
)
1267 unsigned int reg
, sreg
;
1269 for (i
= 0; i
< num_regs_saved_in_regs
; i
++)
1270 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs
[i
].orig_reg
) == REGNO (q
->reg
))
1272 if (q
->saved_reg
&& i
== num_regs_saved_in_regs
)
1274 gcc_assert (i
!= ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs
));
1275 num_regs_saved_in_regs
++;
1277 if (i
!= num_regs_saved_in_regs
)
1279 regs_saved_in_regs
[i
].orig_reg
= q
->reg
;
1280 regs_saved_in_regs
[i
].saved_in_reg
= q
->saved_reg
;
1283 reg
= DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q
->reg
));
1285 sreg
= DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q
->saved_reg
));
1287 sreg
= INVALID_REGNUM
;
1288 reg_save (last_reg_save_label
, reg
, sreg
, q
->cfa_offset
);
1291 queued_reg_saves
= NULL
;
1292 last_reg_save_label
= NULL
;
1295 /* Does INSN clobber any register which QUEUED_REG_SAVES lists a saved
1296 location for? Or, does it clobber a register which we've previously
1297 said that some other register is saved in, and for which we now
1298 have a new location for? */
1301 clobbers_queued_reg_save (const_rtx insn
)
1303 struct queued_reg_save
*q
;
1305 for (q
= queued_reg_saves
; q
; q
= q
->next
)
1308 if (modified_in_p (q
->reg
, insn
))
1310 for (i
= 0; i
< num_regs_saved_in_regs
; i
++)
1311 if (REGNO (q
->reg
) == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs
[i
].orig_reg
)
1312 && modified_in_p (regs_saved_in_regs
[i
].saved_in_reg
, insn
))
1319 /* Entry point for saving the first register into the second. */
1322 dwarf2out_reg_save_reg (const char *label
, rtx reg
, rtx sreg
)
1325 unsigned int regno
, sregno
;
1327 for (i
= 0; i
< num_regs_saved_in_regs
; i
++)
1328 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs
[i
].orig_reg
) == REGNO (reg
))
1330 if (i
== num_regs_saved_in_regs
)
1332 gcc_assert (i
!= ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs
));
1333 num_regs_saved_in_regs
++;
1335 regs_saved_in_regs
[i
].orig_reg
= reg
;
1336 regs_saved_in_regs
[i
].saved_in_reg
= sreg
;
1338 regno
= DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg
));
1339 sregno
= DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (sreg
));
1340 reg_save (label
, regno
, sregno
, 0);
1343 /* What register, if any, is currently saved in REG? */
1346 reg_saved_in (rtx reg
)
1348 unsigned int regn
= REGNO (reg
);
1350 struct queued_reg_save
*q
;
1352 for (q
= queued_reg_saves
; q
; q
= q
->next
)
1353 if (q
->saved_reg
&& regn
== REGNO (q
->saved_reg
))
1356 for (i
= 0; i
< num_regs_saved_in_regs
; i
++)
1357 if (regs_saved_in_regs
[i
].saved_in_reg
1358 && regn
== REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs
[i
].saved_in_reg
))
1359 return regs_saved_in_regs
[i
].orig_reg
;
1365 /* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1366 or setting up the store_reg. The "offset" field holds the integer
1367 value, not an offset. */
1368 static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp
;
1370 /* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
1371 which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
1372 address) or saves a register to the stack or another register.
1373 LABEL indicates the address of EXPR.
1375 This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
1376 cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg. We describe these rules so
1377 users need not read the source code.
1379 The High-Level Picture
1381 Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
1382 assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
1383 should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
1384 work pretty well. If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
1385 enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
1387 Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
1388 This is usually SP, but not always. Again, we deduce that if you
1389 copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
1390 then the new register is the one we will be using for register
1391 saves. This also seems to work.
1393 Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
1394 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
1395 register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
1396 had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
1397 It's also assumed that a copy from a call-saved register to another
1398 register is saving that register if RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on
1399 that instruction. If the copy is from a call-saved register to
1400 the *same* register, that means that the register is now the same
1401 value as in the caller.
1403 Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
1404 offset is nonzero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
1405 use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression. If the offset is 0, we assume that
1406 the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
1408 In addition, if a register has previously been saved to a different
1411 Invariants / Summaries of Rules
1413 cfa current rule for calculating the CFA. It usually
1414 consists of a register and an offset.
1415 cfa_store register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
1416 cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
1417 cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
1418 cfa_temp register holding an integral value. cfa_temp.offset
1419 stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
1420 stack pointer. cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
1421 to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
1423 Rules 1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
1424 with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
1425 cfa.offset. Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
1428 Rules 6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
1429 expression yielding a constant. This sets cfa_temp.reg
1430 and cfa_temp.offset.
1432 Rule 5: Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
1435 Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack. Define offset as the
1436 difference of the original location and cfa_store's
1437 location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
1441 "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
1442 "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
1445 (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
1446 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1447 cfa.offset unchanged
1448 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1449 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1452 (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
1453 {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
1454 effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
1455 cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
1456 cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
1457 if cfa_store.reg==sp
1460 (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1461 effects: cfa.reg = fp
1462 cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
1465 (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1466 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1468 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1469 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1470 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1473 (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
1474 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1476 effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
1477 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
1480 (set <reg> <const_int>)
1481 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1482 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1485 (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
1486 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1487 cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
1490 (set <reg> (high <exp>))
1494 (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
1495 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1496 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1499 (set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
1500 effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
1501 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1503 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1506 (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
1507 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
1508 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1510 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1513 (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
1516 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1517 cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1520 (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
1521 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1522 cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1525 (set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
1526 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1527 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
1528 cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem)
1531 (set <reg> {unspec, unspec_volatile})
1532 effects: target-dependent */
1535 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx expr
, const char *label
)
1537 rtx src
, dest
, span
;
1538 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
;
1540 /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
1541 the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
1542 it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility. Other elements
1543 are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
1544 flag is set in them. */
1545 if (GET_CODE (expr
) == PARALLEL
|| GET_CODE (expr
) == SEQUENCE
)
1548 int limit
= XVECLEN (expr
, 0);
1551 /* PARALLELs have strict read-modify-write semantics, so we
1552 ought to evaluate every rvalue before changing any lvalue.
1553 It's cumbersome to do that in general, but there's an
1554 easy approximation that is enough for all current users:
1555 handle register saves before register assignments. */
1556 if (GET_CODE (expr
) == PARALLEL
)
1557 for (par_index
= 0; par_index
< limit
; par_index
++)
1559 elem
= XVECEXP (expr
, 0, par_index
);
1560 if (GET_CODE (elem
) == SET
1561 && MEM_P (SET_DEST (elem
))
1562 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem
) || par_index
== 0))
1563 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (elem
, label
);
1566 for (par_index
= 0; par_index
< limit
; par_index
++)
1568 elem
= XVECEXP (expr
, 0, par_index
);
1569 if (GET_CODE (elem
) == SET
1570 && (!MEM_P (SET_DEST (elem
)) || GET_CODE (expr
) == SEQUENCE
)
1571 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem
) || par_index
== 0))
1572 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (elem
, label
);
1577 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr
) == SET
);
1579 src
= SET_SRC (expr
);
1580 dest
= SET_DEST (expr
);
1584 rtx rsi
= reg_saved_in (src
);
1589 switch (GET_CODE (dest
))
1592 switch (GET_CODE (src
))
1594 /* Setting FP from SP. */
1596 if (cfa
.reg
== (unsigned) REGNO (src
))
1599 /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP. Make sure src is
1600 relative to the current CFA register.
1602 We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
1603 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
1604 FP. So we just rely on the backends to only set
1605 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns. */
1606 cfa
.reg
= REGNO (dest
);
1607 cfa_temp
.reg
= cfa
.reg
;
1608 cfa_temp
.offset
= cfa
.offset
;
1612 /* Saving a register in a register. */
1613 gcc_assert (!fixed_regs
[REGNO (dest
)]
1614 /* For the SPARC and its register window. */
1615 || (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src
))
1616 == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
));
1617 queue_reg_save (label
, src
, dest
, 0);
1624 if (dest
== stack_pointer_rtx
)
1628 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src
, 1)))
1631 offset
= INTVAL (XEXP (src
, 1));
1634 gcc_assert ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src
, 1))
1636 offset
= cfa_temp
.offset
;
1642 if (XEXP (src
, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
)
1644 /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue. */
1645 gcc_assert (cfa
.reg
== (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
);
1646 cfa
.reg
= STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
;
1648 else if (GET_CODE (src
) == LO_SUM
)
1649 /* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp. */
1652 gcc_assert (XEXP (src
, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx
);
1654 if (GET_CODE (src
) != MINUS
)
1656 if (cfa
.reg
== STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
)
1657 cfa
.offset
+= offset
;
1658 if (cfa_store
.reg
== STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
)
1659 cfa_store
.offset
+= offset
;
1661 else if (dest
== hard_frame_pointer_rtx
)
1664 /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
1665 or adjusting the FP */
1666 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_needed
);
1668 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src
, 0))
1669 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src
, 0)) == cfa
.reg
1670 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src
, 1)) == CONST_INT
);
1671 offset
= INTVAL (XEXP (src
, 1));
1672 if (GET_CODE (src
) != MINUS
)
1674 cfa
.offset
+= offset
;
1675 cfa
.reg
= HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
;
1679 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src
) != MINUS
);
1682 if (REG_P (XEXP (src
, 0))
1683 && REGNO (XEXP (src
, 0)) == cfa
.reg
1684 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src
, 1)) == CONST_INT
)
1686 /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
1687 into the FP later on. */
1688 offset
= - INTVAL (XEXP (src
, 1));
1689 cfa
.offset
+= offset
;
1690 cfa
.reg
= REGNO (dest
);
1691 /* Or used to save regs to the stack. */
1692 cfa_temp
.reg
= cfa
.reg
;
1693 cfa_temp
.offset
= cfa
.offset
;
1697 else if (REG_P (XEXP (src
, 0))
1698 && REGNO (XEXP (src
, 0)) == cfa_temp
.reg
1699 && XEXP (src
, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx
)
1701 /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
1702 of SP for saving registers to the stack. */
1703 gcc_assert (cfa
.reg
== STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
);
1704 cfa_store
.reg
= REGNO (dest
);
1705 cfa_store
.offset
= cfa
.offset
- cfa_temp
.offset
;
1709 else if (GET_CODE (src
) == LO_SUM
1710 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src
, 1)) == CONST_INT
)
1712 cfa_temp
.reg
= REGNO (dest
);
1713 cfa_temp
.offset
= INTVAL (XEXP (src
, 1));
1722 cfa_temp
.reg
= REGNO (dest
);
1723 cfa_temp
.offset
= INTVAL (src
);
1728 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src
, 0))
1729 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src
, 0)) == cfa_temp
.reg
1730 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src
, 1)) == CONST_INT
);
1732 if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest
) != cfa_temp
.reg
)
1733 cfa_temp
.reg
= REGNO (dest
);
1734 cfa_temp
.offset
|= INTVAL (XEXP (src
, 1));
1737 /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
1738 which will fill in all of the bits. */
1745 case UNSPEC_VOLATILE
:
1746 gcc_assert (targetm
.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec
);
1747 targetm
.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec (label
, expr
, XINT (src
, 1));
1754 def_cfa_1 (label
, &cfa
);
1758 gcc_assert (REG_P (src
));
1760 /* Saving a register to the stack. Make sure dest is relative to the
1762 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest
, 0)))
1767 /* We can't handle variable size modifications. */
1768 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest
, 0), 1), 1))
1770 offset
= -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest
, 0), 1), 1));
1772 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest
, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1773 && cfa_store
.reg
== STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
);
1775 cfa_store
.offset
+= offset
;
1776 if (cfa
.reg
== STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
)
1777 cfa
.offset
= cfa_store
.offset
;
1779 offset
= -cfa_store
.offset
;
1785 offset
= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest
));
1786 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest
, 0)) == PRE_INC
)
1789 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest
, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1790 && cfa_store
.reg
== STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
);
1792 cfa_store
.offset
+= offset
;
1793 if (cfa
.reg
== STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
)
1794 cfa
.offset
= cfa_store
.offset
;
1796 offset
= -cfa_store
.offset
;
1800 /* With an offset. */
1807 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (dest
, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
1808 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest
, 0), 0)));
1809 offset
= INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest
, 0), 1));
1810 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest
, 0)) == MINUS
)
1813 regno
= REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest
, 0), 0));
1815 if (cfa_store
.reg
== (unsigned) regno
)
1816 offset
-= cfa_store
.offset
;
1819 gcc_assert (cfa_temp
.reg
== (unsigned) regno
);
1820 offset
-= cfa_temp
.offset
;
1826 /* Without an offset. */
1829 int regno
= REGNO (XEXP (dest
, 0));
1831 if (cfa_store
.reg
== (unsigned) regno
)
1832 offset
= -cfa_store
.offset
;
1835 gcc_assert (cfa_temp
.reg
== (unsigned) regno
);
1836 offset
= -cfa_temp
.offset
;
1843 gcc_assert (cfa_temp
.reg
1844 == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest
, 0), 0)));
1845 offset
= -cfa_temp
.offset
;
1846 cfa_temp
.offset
-= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest
));
1853 if (REGNO (src
) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1854 && REGNO (src
) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1855 && (unsigned) REGNO (src
) == cfa
.reg
)
1857 /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack. */
1859 if (cfa
.offset
== 0)
1861 /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
1862 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
1864 def_cfa_1 (label
, &cfa
);
1865 queue_reg_save (label
, stack_pointer_rtx
, NULL_RTX
, offset
);
1870 /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
1871 calculate the CFA. */
1872 rtx x
= XEXP (dest
, 0);
1876 gcc_assert (REG_P (x
));
1878 cfa
.reg
= REGNO (x
);
1879 cfa
.base_offset
= offset
;
1881 def_cfa_1 (label
, &cfa
);
1886 def_cfa_1 (label
, &cfa
);
1888 span
= targetm
.dwarf_register_span (src
);
1891 queue_reg_save (label
, src
, NULL_RTX
, offset
);
1894 /* We have a PARALLEL describing where the contents of SRC
1895 live. Queue register saves for each piece of the
1899 HOST_WIDE_INT span_offset
= offset
;
1901 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (span
) == PARALLEL
);
1903 limit
= XVECLEN (span
, 0);
1904 for (par_index
= 0; par_index
< limit
; par_index
++)
1906 rtx elem
= XVECEXP (span
, 0, par_index
);
1908 queue_reg_save (label
, elem
, NULL_RTX
, span_offset
);
1909 span_offset
+= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (elem
));
1920 /* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
1921 sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
1922 register to the stack. If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state.
1924 If AFTER_P is false, we're being called before the insn is emitted,
1925 otherwise after. Call instructions get invoked twice. */
1928 dwarf2out_frame_debug (rtx insn
, bool after_p
)
1933 if (insn
== NULL_RTX
)
1937 /* Flush any queued register saves. */
1938 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1940 /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info. */
1943 == (unsigned long)DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
));
1945 cfa
.reg
= STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
;
1948 cfa_temp
.offset
= 0;
1950 for (i
= 0; i
< num_regs_saved_in_regs
; i
++)
1952 regs_saved_in_regs
[i
].orig_reg
= NULL_RTX
;
1953 regs_saved_in_regs
[i
].saved_in_reg
= NULL_RTX
;
1955 num_regs_saved_in_regs
= 0;
1959 if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn
) || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn
))
1960 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1962 if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn
))
1964 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
)
1965 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn
, after_p
);
1969 label
= dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1970 src
= find_reg_note (insn
, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR
, NULL_RTX
);
1972 insn
= XEXP (src
, 0);
1974 insn
= PATTERN (insn
);
1976 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn
, label
);
1981 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
1982 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc
1983 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi
);
1985 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
1986 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi
)
1991 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save
:
1992 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused
;
1994 case DW_CFA_set_loc
:
1995 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1
:
1996 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2
:
1997 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4
:
1998 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8
:
1999 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr
;
2002 case DW_CFA_offset_extended
:
2003 case DW_CFA_def_cfa
:
2004 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf
:
2005 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf
:
2006 case DW_CFA_restore_extended
:
2007 case DW_CFA_undefined
:
2008 case DW_CFA_same_value
:
2009 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register
:
2010 case DW_CFA_register
:
2011 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num
;
2013 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset
:
2014 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size
:
2015 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf
:
2016 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset
;
2018 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression
:
2019 case DW_CFA_expression
:
2020 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc
;
2027 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
2028 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc
2029 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi
);
2031 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
2032 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi
)
2036 case DW_CFA_def_cfa
:
2037 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf
:
2039 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf
:
2040 case DW_CFA_offset_extended
:
2041 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset
;
2043 case DW_CFA_register
:
2044 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num
;
2047 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused
;
2051 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2053 /* Switch to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
2054 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic label
2058 switch_to_eh_frame_section (void)
2062 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
2063 if (eh_frame_section
== 0)
2067 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
)
2073 fde_encoding
= ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
2075 per_encoding
= ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
2077 lsda_encoding
= ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
2079 flags
= ((! flag_pic
2080 || ((fde_encoding
& 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2081 && (fde_encoding
& 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2082 && (per_encoding
& 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2083 && (per_encoding
& 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2084 && (lsda_encoding
& 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2085 && (lsda_encoding
& 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
))
2086 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE
);
2089 flags
= SECTION_WRITE
;
2090 eh_frame_section
= get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
, flags
, NULL
);
2094 if (eh_frame_section
)
2095 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section
);
2098 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Put the information in
2099 the data section and emit special labels to guide collect2. */
2100 switch_to_section (data_section
);
2101 label
= get_file_function_name ("F");
2102 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file
, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE
));
2103 targetm
.asm_out
.globalize_label (asm_out_file
,
2104 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label
));
2105 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label
));
2109 /* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s). */
2112 output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref cfi
, dw_fde_ref fde
, int for_eh
)
2115 if (cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
== DW_CFA_advance_loc
)
2116 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
2117 | (cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_offset
& 0x3f)),
2118 "DW_CFA_advance_loc " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX
,
2119 cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_offset
);
2120 else if (cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
== DW_CFA_offset
)
2122 r
= DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_reg_num
, for_eh
);
2123 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
| (r
& 0x3f)),
2124 "DW_CFA_offset, column 0x%lx", r
);
2125 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd2
.dw_cfi_offset
, NULL
);
2127 else if (cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
== DW_CFA_restore
)
2129 r
= DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_reg_num
, for_eh
);
2130 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
| (r
& 0x3f)),
2131 "DW_CFA_restore, column 0x%lx", r
);
2135 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
,
2136 "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
));
2138 switch (cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
)
2140 case DW_CFA_set_loc
:
2142 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2143 ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
2144 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode
, cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_addr
),
2147 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
,
2148 cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_addr
, NULL
);
2149 fde
->dw_fde_current_label
= cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_addr
;
2152 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1
:
2153 dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_addr
,
2154 fde
->dw_fde_current_label
, NULL
);
2155 fde
->dw_fde_current_label
= cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_addr
;
2158 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2
:
2159 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_addr
,
2160 fde
->dw_fde_current_label
, NULL
);
2161 fde
->dw_fde_current_label
= cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_addr
;
2164 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4
:
2165 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_addr
,
2166 fde
->dw_fde_current_label
, NULL
);
2167 fde
->dw_fde_current_label
= cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_addr
;
2170 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8
:
2171 dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_addr
,
2172 fde
->dw_fde_current_label
, NULL
);
2173 fde
->dw_fde_current_label
= cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_addr
;
2176 case DW_CFA_offset_extended
:
2177 case DW_CFA_def_cfa
:
2178 r
= DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_reg_num
, for_eh
);
2179 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r
, NULL
);
2180 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd2
.dw_cfi_offset
, NULL
);
2183 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf
:
2184 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf
:
2185 r
= DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_reg_num
, for_eh
);
2186 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r
, NULL
);
2187 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd2
.dw_cfi_offset
, NULL
);
2190 case DW_CFA_restore_extended
:
2191 case DW_CFA_undefined
:
2192 case DW_CFA_same_value
:
2193 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register
:
2194 r
= DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_reg_num
, for_eh
);
2195 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r
, NULL
);
2198 case DW_CFA_register
:
2199 r
= DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_reg_num
, for_eh
);
2200 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r
, NULL
);
2201 r
= DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd2
.dw_cfi_reg_num
, for_eh
);
2202 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r
, NULL
);
2205 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset
:
2206 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size
:
2207 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_offset
, NULL
);
2210 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf
:
2211 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_offset
, NULL
);
2214 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save
:
2217 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression
:
2218 case DW_CFA_expression
:
2219 output_cfa_loc (cfi
);
2222 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended
:
2223 /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf. */
2232 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
2233 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
2234 location of saved registers. */
2237 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh
)
2242 char l1
[20], l2
[20], section_start_label
[20];
2243 bool any_lsda_needed
= false;
2244 char augmentation
[6];
2245 int augmentation_size
;
2246 int fde_encoding
= DW_EH_PE_absptr
;
2247 int per_encoding
= DW_EH_PE_absptr
;
2248 int lsda_encoding
= DW_EH_PE_absptr
;
2251 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
2252 if (fde_table_in_use
== 0)
2255 /* If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to emit an empty label for
2256 an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We want to avoid
2257 having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to is
2258 discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function
2259 template in C++ requires EH information, but an explicit
2260 specialization doesn't. */
2261 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
2262 && ! flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables
2265 for (i
= 0; i
< fde_table_in_use
; i
++)
2266 if ((fde_table
[i
].nothrow
|| fde_table
[i
].all_throwers_are_sibcalls
)
2267 && !fde_table
[i
].uses_eh_lsda
2268 && ! DECL_WEAK (fde_table
[i
].decl
))
2269 targetm
.asm_out
.unwind_label (asm_out_file
, fde_table
[i
].decl
,
2270 for_eh
, /* empty */ 1);
2272 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't
2273 emit any EH unwind information. Note that if exceptions aren't
2274 enabled, we won't have collected nothrow information, and if we
2275 asked for asynchronous tables, we always want this info. */
2278 bool any_eh_needed
= !flag_exceptions
|| flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables
;
2280 for (i
= 0; i
< fde_table_in_use
; i
++)
2281 if (fde_table
[i
].uses_eh_lsda
)
2282 any_eh_needed
= any_lsda_needed
= true;
2283 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
&& DECL_WEAK (fde_table
[i
].decl
))
2284 any_eh_needed
= true;
2285 else if (! fde_table
[i
].nothrow
2286 && ! fde_table
[i
].all_throwers_are_sibcalls
)
2287 any_eh_needed
= true;
2289 if (! any_eh_needed
)
2293 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
2298 switch_to_eh_frame_section ();
2301 if (!debug_frame_section
)
2302 debug_frame_section
= get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
,
2303 SECTION_DEBUG
, NULL
);
2304 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section
);
2307 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label
, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
, for_eh
);
2308 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, section_start_label
);
2310 /* Output the CIE. */
2311 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1
, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL
, for_eh
);
2312 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2
, CIE_END_LABEL
, for_eh
);
2313 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
- DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
== 4 && !for_eh
)
2314 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
2315 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
2316 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh
? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, l2
, l1
,
2317 "Length of Common Information Entry");
2318 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, l1
);
2320 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
2321 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
2322 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh
? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
),
2323 (for_eh
? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID
),
2324 "CIE Identifier Tag");
2326 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_CIE_VERSION
, "CIE Version");
2328 augmentation
[0] = 0;
2329 augmentation_size
= 0;
2335 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
2336 augmentation section.
2337 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
2338 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
2339 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
2341 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
2342 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
2344 fde_encoding
= ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
2345 per_encoding
= ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
2346 lsda_encoding
= ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
2348 p
= augmentation
+ 1;
2349 if (eh_personality_libfunc
)
2352 augmentation_size
+= 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding
);
2353 assemble_external_libcall (eh_personality_libfunc
);
2355 if (any_lsda_needed
)
2358 augmentation_size
+= 1;
2360 if (fde_encoding
!= DW_EH_PE_absptr
)
2363 augmentation_size
+= 1;
2365 if (p
> augmentation
+ 1)
2367 augmentation
[0] = 'z';
2371 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
2372 if (eh_personality_libfunc
&& per_encoding
== DW_EH_PE_aligned
)
2374 int offset
= ( 4 /* Length */
2376 + 1 /* CIE version */
2377 + strlen (augmentation
) + 1 /* Augmentation */
2378 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
2379 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
)
2381 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
2382 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
2383 int pad
= -offset
& (PTR_SIZE
- 1);
2385 augmentation_size
+= pad
;
2387 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
2388 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
2389 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size
) == 1);
2393 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation
, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
2394 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
2395 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
,
2396 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
2398 return_reg
= DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
, for_eh
);
2399 if (DW_CIE_VERSION
== 1)
2400 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg
, "CIE RA Column");
2402 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg
, "CIE RA Column");
2404 if (augmentation
[0])
2406 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size
, "Augmentation size");
2407 if (eh_personality_libfunc
)
2409 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding
, "Personality (%s)",
2410 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding
));
2411 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding
,
2412 eh_personality_libfunc
,
2416 if (any_lsda_needed
)
2417 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding
, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
2418 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding
));
2420 if (fde_encoding
!= DW_EH_PE_absptr
)
2421 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding
, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
2422 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding
));
2425 for (cfi
= cie_cfi_head
; cfi
!= NULL
; cfi
= cfi
->dw_cfi_next
)
2426 output_cfi (cfi
, NULL
, for_eh
);
2428 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
2429 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file
,
2430 floor_log2 (for_eh
? PTR_SIZE
: DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
));
2431 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, l2
);
2433 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
2434 for (i
= 0; i
< fde_table_in_use
; i
++)
2436 fde
= &fde_table
[i
];
2438 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
2439 if (for_eh
&& !flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables
&& flag_exceptions
2440 && (fde
->nothrow
|| fde
->all_throwers_are_sibcalls
)
2441 && ! (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
&& DECL_WEAK (fde_table
[i
].decl
))
2442 && !fde
->uses_eh_lsda
)
2445 targetm
.asm_out
.unwind_label (asm_out_file
, fde
->decl
, for_eh
, /* empty */ 0);
2446 targetm
.asm_out
.internal_label (asm_out_file
, FDE_LABEL
, for_eh
+ i
* 2);
2447 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1
, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL
, for_eh
+ i
* 2);
2448 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2
, FDE_END_LABEL
, for_eh
+ i
* 2);
2449 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
- DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
== 4 && !for_eh
)
2450 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
2451 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
2452 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh
? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, l2
, l1
,
2454 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, l1
);
2457 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1
, section_start_label
, "FDE CIE offset");
2459 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, section_start_label
,
2460 debug_frame_section
, "FDE CIE offset");
2464 if (fde
->dw_fde_switched_sections
)
2466 rtx sym_ref2
= gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode
,
2467 fde
->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label
);
2468 rtx sym_ref3
= gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode
,
2469 fde
->dw_fde_hot_section_label
);
2470 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref2
) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL
;
2471 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref3
) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL
;
2472 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding
, sym_ref3
, false,
2473 "FDE initial location");
2474 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding
),
2475 fde
->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label
,
2476 fde
->dw_fde_hot_section_label
,
2477 "FDE address range");
2478 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding
, sym_ref2
, false,
2479 "FDE initial location");
2480 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding
),
2481 fde
->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label
,
2482 fde
->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label
,
2483 "FDE address range");
2487 rtx sym_ref
= gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode
, fde
->dw_fde_begin
);
2488 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref
) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL
;
2489 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding
,
2492 "FDE initial location");
2493 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding
),
2494 fde
->dw_fde_end
, fde
->dw_fde_begin
,
2495 "FDE address range");
2500 if (fde
->dw_fde_switched_sections
)
2502 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
,
2503 fde
->dw_fde_hot_section_label
,
2504 "FDE initial location");
2505 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
,
2506 fde
->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label
,
2507 fde
->dw_fde_hot_section_label
,
2508 "FDE address range");
2509 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
,
2510 fde
->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label
,
2511 "FDE initial location");
2512 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
,
2513 fde
->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label
,
2514 fde
->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label
,
2515 "FDE address range");
2519 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, fde
->dw_fde_begin
,
2520 "FDE initial location");
2521 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
,
2522 fde
->dw_fde_end
, fde
->dw_fde_begin
,
2523 "FDE address range");
2527 if (augmentation
[0])
2529 if (any_lsda_needed
)
2531 int size
= size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding
);
2533 if (lsda_encoding
== DW_EH_PE_aligned
)
2535 int offset
= ( 4 /* Length */
2536 + 4 /* CIE offset */
2537 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding
)
2538 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
2539 int pad
= -offset
& (PTR_SIZE
- 1);
2542 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size
) == 1);
2545 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size
, "Augmentation size");
2547 if (fde
->uses_eh_lsda
)
2549 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1
, "LLSDA",
2550 fde
->funcdef_number
);
2551 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2552 lsda_encoding
, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode
, l1
),
2553 false, "Language Specific Data Area");
2557 if (lsda_encoding
== DW_EH_PE_aligned
)
2558 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file
, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE
));
2560 (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding
), 0,
2561 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
2565 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
2568 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
2570 fde
->dw_fde_current_label
= fde
->dw_fde_begin
;
2571 for (cfi
= fde
->dw_fde_cfi
; cfi
!= NULL
; cfi
= cfi
->dw_cfi_next
)
2572 output_cfi (cfi
, fde
, for_eh
);
2574 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
2575 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file
,
2576 floor_log2 ((for_eh
? PTR_SIZE
: DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
)));
2577 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, l2
);
2580 if (for_eh
&& targetm
.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info
)
2581 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
2582 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2583 /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
2584 get a value of 0. Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it. */
2585 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file
, 0);
2588 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
2593 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
2597 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
2598 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
2600 char label
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
2604 current_function_func_begin_label
= NULL
;
2606 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2607 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c
2608 for call-site information. We must emit this label if it might
2610 if ((! flag_exceptions
|| USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS
)
2611 && ! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2614 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2618 switch_to_section (function_section (current_function_decl
));
2619 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label
, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
,
2620 current_function_funcdef_no
);
2621 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file
, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
,
2622 current_function_funcdef_no
);
2623 dup_label
= xstrdup (label
);
2624 current_function_func_begin_label
= dup_label
;
2626 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2627 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
2628 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2632 /* Expand the fde table if necessary. */
2633 if (fde_table_in_use
== fde_table_allocated
)
2635 fde_table_allocated
+= FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT
;
2636 fde_table
= ggc_realloc (fde_table
,
2637 fde_table_allocated
* sizeof (dw_fde_node
));
2638 memset (fde_table
+ fde_table_in_use
, 0,
2639 FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT
* sizeof (dw_fde_node
));
2642 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
2643 current_funcdef_fde
= fde_table_in_use
;
2645 /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table. */
2646 fde
= &fde_table
[fde_table_in_use
++];
2647 fde
->decl
= current_function_decl
;
2648 fde
->dw_fde_begin
= dup_label
;
2649 fde
->dw_fde_current_label
= dup_label
;
2650 fde
->dw_fde_hot_section_label
= NULL
;
2651 fde
->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label
= NULL
;
2652 fde
->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label
= NULL
;
2653 fde
->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label
= NULL
;
2654 fde
->dw_fde_switched_sections
= false;
2655 fde
->dw_fde_end
= NULL
;
2656 fde
->dw_fde_cfi
= NULL
;
2657 fde
->funcdef_number
= current_function_funcdef_no
;
2658 fde
->nothrow
= TREE_NOTHROW (current_function_decl
);
2659 fde
->uses_eh_lsda
= cfun
->uses_eh_lsda
;
2660 fde
->all_throwers_are_sibcalls
= cfun
->all_throwers_are_sibcalls
;
2662 args_size
= old_args_size
= 0;
2664 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
2665 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
2666 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2668 dwarf2out_source_line (line
, file
);
2672 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
2673 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
2677 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
2678 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
2681 char label
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
2683 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
2685 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label
, FUNC_END_LABEL
,
2686 current_function_funcdef_no
);
2687 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, label
);
2688 fde
= &fde_table
[fde_table_in_use
- 1];
2689 fde
->dw_fde_end
= xstrdup (label
);
2693 dwarf2out_frame_init (void)
2695 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table. */
2696 fde_table
= ggc_alloc_cleared (FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT
* sizeof (dw_fde_node
));
2697 fde_table_allocated
= FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT
;
2698 fde_table_in_use
= 0;
2700 /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's. Do it now for the
2701 sake of lookup_cfa. */
2703 /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP. */
2704 dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL
, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
);
2706 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
2707 if (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
|| DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
)
2708 initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
);
2713 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
2715 /* Output call frame information. */
2716 if (DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
)
2717 output_call_frame_info (0);
2719 #ifndef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2720 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
2721 if (! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS
&& (flag_unwind_tables
|| flag_exceptions
))
2722 output_call_frame_info (1);
2726 /* Note that the current function section is being used for code. */
2729 dwarf2out_note_section_used (void)
2731 section
*sec
= current_function_section ();
2732 if (sec
== text_section
)
2733 text_section_used
= true;
2734 else if (sec
== cold_text_section
)
2735 cold_text_section_used
= true;
2739 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
2745 fde
= &fde_table
[fde_table_in_use
- 1];
2746 fde
->dw_fde_switched_sections
= true;
2747 fde
->dw_fde_hot_section_label
= cfun
->hot_section_label
;
2748 fde
->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label
= cfun
->hot_section_end_label
;
2749 fde
->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label
= cfun
->cold_section_label
;
2750 fde
->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label
= cfun
->cold_section_end_label
;
2751 have_multiple_function_sections
= true;
2753 /* Reset the current label on switching text sections, so that we
2754 don't attempt to advance_loc4 between labels in different sections. */
2755 fde
->dw_fde_current_label
= NULL
;
2757 /* There is no need to mark used sections when not debugging. */
2758 if (cold_text_section
!= NULL
)
2759 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
2763 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
2764 for emitting location expressions. */
2766 /* Data about a single source file. */
2767 struct dwarf_file_data
GTY(())
2769 const char * filename
;
2773 /* We need some way to distinguish DW_OP_addr with a direct symbol
2774 relocation from DW_OP_addr with a dtp-relative symbol relocation. */
2775 #define INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr (0x100 + DW_OP_addr)
2778 typedef struct dw_val_struct
*dw_val_ref
;
2779 typedef struct die_struct
*dw_die_ref
;
2780 typedef const struct die_struct
*const_dw_die_ref
;
2781 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct
*dw_loc_descr_ref
;
2782 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct
*dw_loc_list_ref
;
2784 /* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs. Values
2785 can take on several forms. The forms that are used in this
2786 implementation are listed below. */
2791 dw_val_class_offset
,
2793 dw_val_class_loc_list
,
2794 dw_val_class_range_list
,
2796 dw_val_class_unsigned_const
,
2797 dw_val_class_long_long
,
2800 dw_val_class_die_ref
,
2801 dw_val_class_fde_ref
,
2802 dw_val_class_lbl_id
,
2803 dw_val_class_lineptr
,
2805 dw_val_class_macptr
,
2809 /* Describe a double word constant value. */
2810 /* ??? Every instance of long_long in the code really means CONST_DOUBLE. */
2812 typedef struct dw_long_long_struct
GTY(())
2819 /* Describe a floating point constant value, or a vector constant value. */
2821 typedef struct dw_vec_struct
GTY(())
2823 unsigned char * GTY((length ("%h.length"))) array
;
2829 /* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
2830 represented internally. */
2832 typedef struct dw_val_struct
GTY(())
2834 enum dw_val_class val_class
;
2835 union dw_val_struct_union
2837 rtx
GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_addr"))) val_addr
;
2838 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_offset"))) val_offset
;
2839 dw_loc_list_ref
GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc_list"))) val_loc_list
;
2840 dw_loc_descr_ref
GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc"))) val_loc
;
2841 HOST_WIDE_INT
GTY ((default)) val_int
;
2842 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_unsigned_const"))) val_unsigned
;
2843 dw_long_long_const
GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_long_long"))) val_long_long
;
2844 dw_vec_const
GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vec"))) val_vec
;
2845 struct dw_val_die_union
2849 } GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_die_ref"))) val_die_ref
;
2850 unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_fde_ref"))) val_fde_index
;
2851 struct indirect_string_node
* GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_str"))) val_str
;
2852 char * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_lbl_id"))) val_lbl_id
;
2853 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_flag"))) val_flag
;
2854 struct dwarf_file_data
* GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_file"))) val_file
;
2856 GTY ((desc ("%1.val_class"))) v
;
2860 /* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
2863 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct
GTY(())
2865 dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next
;
2866 enum dwarf_location_atom dw_loc_opc
;
2867 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1
;
2868 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2
;
2873 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
2874 so you can track variables that are in different places over
2875 their entire life. */
2876 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct
GTY(())
2878 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next
;
2879 const char *begin
; /* Label for begin address of range */
2880 const char *end
; /* Label for end address of range */
2881 char *ll_symbol
; /* Label for beginning of location list.
2882 Only on head of list */
2883 const char *section
; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
2884 dw_loc_descr_ref expr
;
2887 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2889 static const char *dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned);
2890 static dw_loc_descr_ref
new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom
,
2891 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
);
2892 static void add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref
*, dw_loc_descr_ref
);
2893 static unsigned long size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref
);
2894 static unsigned long size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref
);
2895 static void output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref
);
2896 static void output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref
);
2898 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
2901 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op
)
2906 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr
:
2907 return "DW_OP_addr";
2909 return "DW_OP_deref";
2911 return "DW_OP_const1u";
2913 return "DW_OP_const1s";
2915 return "DW_OP_const2u";
2917 return "DW_OP_const2s";
2919 return "DW_OP_const4u";
2921 return "DW_OP_const4s";
2923 return "DW_OP_const8u";
2925 return "DW_OP_const8s";
2927 return "DW_OP_constu";
2929 return "DW_OP_consts";
2933 return "DW_OP_drop";
2935 return "DW_OP_over";
2937 return "DW_OP_pick";
2939 return "DW_OP_swap";
2943 return "DW_OP_xderef";
2951 return "DW_OP_minus";
2963 return "DW_OP_plus";
2964 case DW_OP_plus_uconst
:
2965 return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
2971 return "DW_OP_shra";
2989 return "DW_OP_skip";
2991 return "DW_OP_lit0";
2993 return "DW_OP_lit1";
2995 return "DW_OP_lit2";
2997 return "DW_OP_lit3";
2999 return "DW_OP_lit4";
3001 return "DW_OP_lit5";
3003 return "DW_OP_lit6";
3005 return "DW_OP_lit7";
3007 return "DW_OP_lit8";
3009 return "DW_OP_lit9";
3011 return "DW_OP_lit10";
3013 return "DW_OP_lit11";
3015 return "DW_OP_lit12";
3017 return "DW_OP_lit13";
3019 return "DW_OP_lit14";
3021 return "DW_OP_lit15";
3023 return "DW_OP_lit16";
3025 return "DW_OP_lit17";
3027 return "DW_OP_lit18";
3029 return "DW_OP_lit19";
3031 return "DW_OP_lit20";
3033 return "DW_OP_lit21";
3035 return "DW_OP_lit22";
3037 return "DW_OP_lit23";
3039 return "DW_OP_lit24";
3041 return "DW_OP_lit25";
3043 return "DW_OP_lit26";
3045 return "DW_OP_lit27";
3047 return "DW_OP_lit28";
3049 return "DW_OP_lit29";
3051 return "DW_OP_lit30";
3053 return "DW_OP_lit31";
3055 return "DW_OP_reg0";
3057 return "DW_OP_reg1";
3059 return "DW_OP_reg2";
3061 return "DW_OP_reg3";
3063 return "DW_OP_reg4";
3065 return "DW_OP_reg5";
3067 return "DW_OP_reg6";
3069 return "DW_OP_reg7";
3071 return "DW_OP_reg8";
3073 return "DW_OP_reg9";
3075 return "DW_OP_reg10";
3077 return "DW_OP_reg11";
3079 return "DW_OP_reg12";
3081 return "DW_OP_reg13";
3083 return "DW_OP_reg14";
3085 return "DW_OP_reg15";
3087 return "DW_OP_reg16";
3089 return "DW_OP_reg17";
3091 return "DW_OP_reg18";
3093 return "DW_OP_reg19";
3095 return "DW_OP_reg20";
3097 return "DW_OP_reg21";
3099 return "DW_OP_reg22";
3101 return "DW_OP_reg23";
3103 return "DW_OP_reg24";
3105 return "DW_OP_reg25";
3107 return "DW_OP_reg26";
3109 return "DW_OP_reg27";
3111 return "DW_OP_reg28";
3113 return "DW_OP_reg29";
3115 return "DW_OP_reg30";
3117 return "DW_OP_reg31";
3119 return "DW_OP_breg0";
3121 return "DW_OP_breg1";
3123 return "DW_OP_breg2";
3125 return "DW_OP_breg3";
3127 return "DW_OP_breg4";
3129 return "DW_OP_breg5";
3131 return "DW_OP_breg6";
3133 return "DW_OP_breg7";
3135 return "DW_OP_breg8";
3137 return "DW_OP_breg9";
3139 return "DW_OP_breg10";
3141 return "DW_OP_breg11";
3143 return "DW_OP_breg12";
3145 return "DW_OP_breg13";
3147 return "DW_OP_breg14";
3149 return "DW_OP_breg15";
3151 return "DW_OP_breg16";
3153 return "DW_OP_breg17";
3155 return "DW_OP_breg18";
3157 return "DW_OP_breg19";
3159 return "DW_OP_breg20";
3161 return "DW_OP_breg21";
3163 return "DW_OP_breg22";
3165 return "DW_OP_breg23";
3167 return "DW_OP_breg24";
3169 return "DW_OP_breg25";
3171 return "DW_OP_breg26";
3173 return "DW_OP_breg27";
3175 return "DW_OP_breg28";
3177 return "DW_OP_breg29";
3179 return "DW_OP_breg30";
3181 return "DW_OP_breg31";
3183 return "DW_OP_regx";
3185 return "DW_OP_fbreg";
3187 return "DW_OP_bregx";
3189 return "DW_OP_piece";
3190 case DW_OP_deref_size
:
3191 return "DW_OP_deref_size";
3192 case DW_OP_xderef_size
:
3193 return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
3196 case DW_OP_push_object_address
:
3197 return "DW_OP_push_object_address";
3199 return "DW_OP_call2";
3201 return "DW_OP_call4";
3202 case DW_OP_call_ref
:
3203 return "DW_OP_call_ref";
3204 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address
:
3205 return "DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address";
3206 case DW_OP_GNU_uninit
:
3207 return "DW_OP_GNU_uninit";
3209 return "OP_<unknown>";
3213 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
3214 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
3215 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
3217 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
3218 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op
, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1
,
3219 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2
)
3221 dw_loc_descr_ref descr
= ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node
));
3223 descr
->dw_loc_opc
= op
;
3224 descr
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.val_class
= dw_val_class_unsigned_const
;
3225 descr
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_unsigned
= oprnd1
;
3226 descr
->dw_loc_oprnd2
.val_class
= dw_val_class_unsigned_const
;
3227 descr
->dw_loc_oprnd2
.v
.val_unsigned
= oprnd2
;
3232 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
3235 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref
*list_head
, dw_loc_descr_ref descr
)
3237 dw_loc_descr_ref
*d
;
3239 /* Find the end of the chain. */
3240 for (d
= list_head
; (*d
) != NULL
; d
= &(*d
)->dw_loc_next
)
3246 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
3248 static unsigned long
3249 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc
)
3251 unsigned long size
= 1;
3253 switch (loc
->dw_loc_opc
)
3256 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr
:
3257 size
+= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
;
3276 size
+= size_of_uleb128 (loc
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_unsigned
);
3279 size
+= size_of_sleb128 (loc
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_int
);
3284 case DW_OP_plus_uconst
:
3285 size
+= size_of_uleb128 (loc
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_unsigned
);
3323 size
+= size_of_sleb128 (loc
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_int
);
3326 size
+= size_of_uleb128 (loc
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_unsigned
);
3329 size
+= size_of_sleb128 (loc
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_int
);
3332 size
+= size_of_uleb128 (loc
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_unsigned
);
3333 size
+= size_of_sleb128 (loc
->dw_loc_oprnd2
.v
.val_int
);
3336 size
+= size_of_uleb128 (loc
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_unsigned
);
3338 case DW_OP_deref_size
:
3339 case DW_OP_xderef_size
:
3348 case DW_OP_call_ref
:
3349 size
+= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
;
3358 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
3360 static unsigned long
3361 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc
)
3366 /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
3367 field, to avoid writing to a PCH file. */
3368 for (size
= 0, l
= loc
; l
!= NULL
; l
= l
->dw_loc_next
)
3370 if (l
->dw_loc_opc
== DW_OP_skip
|| l
->dw_loc_opc
== DW_OP_bra
)
3372 size
+= size_of_loc_descr (l
);
3377 for (size
= 0, l
= loc
; l
!= NULL
; l
= l
->dw_loc_next
)
3379 l
->dw_loc_addr
= size
;
3380 size
+= size_of_loc_descr (l
);
3386 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any). */
3389 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc
)
3391 dw_val_ref val1
= &loc
->dw_loc_oprnd1
;
3392 dw_val_ref val2
= &loc
->dw_loc_oprnd2
;
3394 switch (loc
->dw_loc_opc
)
3396 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3398 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, val1
->v
.val_addr
, NULL
);
3402 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1
->v
.val_int
, NULL
);
3406 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1
->v
.val_int
, NULL
);
3410 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG
>= 64);
3411 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1
->v
.val_int
, NULL
);
3418 gcc_assert (val1
->val_class
== dw_val_class_loc
);
3419 offset
= val1
->v
.val_loc
->dw_loc_addr
- (loc
->dw_loc_addr
+ 3);
3421 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset
, NULL
);
3434 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
3435 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
3436 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
3437 only doing unwinding. */
3442 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1
->v
.val_int
, NULL
);
3445 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1
->v
.val_unsigned
, NULL
);
3448 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1
->v
.val_int
, NULL
);
3451 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1
->v
.val_int
, NULL
);
3453 case DW_OP_plus_uconst
:
3454 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1
->v
.val_unsigned
, NULL
);
3488 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1
->v
.val_int
, NULL
);
3491 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1
->v
.val_unsigned
, NULL
);
3494 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1
->v
.val_int
, NULL
);
3497 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1
->v
.val_unsigned
, NULL
);
3498 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2
->v
.val_int
, NULL
);
3501 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1
->v
.val_unsigned
, NULL
);
3503 case DW_OP_deref_size
:
3504 case DW_OP_xderef_size
:
3505 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1
->v
.val_int
, NULL
);
3508 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr
:
3509 if (targetm
.asm_out
.output_dwarf_dtprel
)
3511 targetm
.asm_out
.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file
,
3514 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file
);
3521 /* Other codes have no operands. */
3526 /* Output a sequence of location operations. */
3529 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc
)
3531 for (; loc
!= NULL
; loc
= loc
->dw_loc_next
)
3533 /* Output the opcode. */
3534 dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc
->dw_loc_opc
,
3535 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc
->dw_loc_opc
));
3537 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
3538 output_loc_operands (loc
);
3542 /* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
3543 description based on a cfi entry with a complex address. */
3546 output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref cfi
)
3548 dw_loc_descr_ref loc
;
3551 /* Output the size of the block. */
3552 loc
= cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_loc
;
3553 size
= size_of_locs (loc
);
3554 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size
, NULL
);
3556 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
3557 output_loc_sequence (loc
);
3560 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
3561 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
3564 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct
*
3565 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location
*cfa
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
)
3567 struct dw_loc_descr_struct
*head
, *tmp
;
3569 offset
+= cfa
->offset
;
3573 if (cfa
->base_offset
)
3576 head
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0
+ cfa
->reg
, cfa
->base_offset
, 0);
3578 head
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx
, cfa
->reg
, cfa
->base_offset
);
3580 else if (cfa
->reg
<= 31)
3581 head
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0
+ cfa
->reg
, 0, 0);
3583 head
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx
, cfa
->reg
, 0);
3585 head
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.val_class
= dw_val_class_const
;
3586 tmp
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref
, 0, 0);
3587 add_loc_descr (&head
, tmp
);
3590 tmp
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst
, offset
, 0);
3591 add_loc_descr (&head
, tmp
);
3598 head
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0
+ cfa
->reg
, 0, 0);
3600 head
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx
, cfa
->reg
, 0);
3601 else if (cfa
->reg
<= 31)
3602 head
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0
+ cfa
->reg
, offset
, 0);
3604 head
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx
, cfa
->reg
, offset
);
3610 /* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
3611 descriptor sequence. */
3614 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location
*cfa
, struct dw_loc_descr_struct
*loc
)
3616 struct dw_loc_descr_struct
*ptr
;
3618 cfa
->base_offset
= 0;
3622 for (ptr
= loc
; ptr
!= NULL
; ptr
= ptr
->dw_loc_next
)
3624 enum dwarf_location_atom op
= ptr
->dw_loc_opc
;
3660 cfa
->reg
= op
- DW_OP_reg0
;
3663 cfa
->reg
= ptr
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_int
;
3697 cfa
->reg
= op
- DW_OP_breg0
;
3698 cfa
->base_offset
= ptr
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_int
;
3701 cfa
->reg
= ptr
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_int
;
3702 cfa
->base_offset
= ptr
->dw_loc_oprnd2
.v
.val_int
;
3707 case DW_OP_plus_uconst
:
3708 cfa
->offset
= ptr
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_unsigned
;
3711 internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented",
3712 dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr
->dw_loc_opc
));
3716 #endif /* .debug_frame support */
3718 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
3719 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3721 /* .debug_str support. */
3722 static int output_indirect_string (void **, void *);
3724 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
3725 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
3726 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
3727 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
3728 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
3729 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
3730 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3731 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3732 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree
);
3733 static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree
);
3734 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree
, int);
3735 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree
, tree
);
3736 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree
);
3737 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx
);
3738 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree
);
3740 /* The debug hooks structure. */
3742 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks
=
3748 dwarf2out_start_source_file
,
3749 dwarf2out_end_source_file
,
3750 dwarf2out_begin_block
,
3751 dwarf2out_end_block
,
3752 dwarf2out_ignore_block
,
3753 dwarf2out_source_line
,
3754 dwarf2out_begin_prologue
,
3755 debug_nothing_int_charstar
, /* end_prologue */
3756 dwarf2out_end_epilogue
,
3757 dwarf2out_begin_function
,
3758 debug_nothing_int
, /* end_function */
3759 dwarf2out_decl
, /* function_decl */
3760 dwarf2out_global_decl
,
3761 dwarf2out_type_decl
, /* type_decl */
3762 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl
,
3763 debug_nothing_tree
, /* deferred_inline_function */
3764 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
3765 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
3766 something tries to reference them. */
3767 dwarf2out_abstract_function
, /* outlining_inline_function */
3768 debug_nothing_rtx
, /* label */
3769 debug_nothing_int
, /* handle_pch */
3770 dwarf2out_var_location
,
3771 dwarf2out_switch_text_section
,
3772 1 /* start_end_main_source_file */
3776 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
3777 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
3778 throughout the remainder of this file. */
3780 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
3781 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
3782 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
3783 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
3785 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
3786 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
3788 typedef long int dw_offset
;
3790 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
3792 typedef struct dw_attr_struct
*dw_attr_ref
;
3793 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct
*dw_line_info_ref
;
3794 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct
*dw_separate_line_info_ref
;
3795 typedef struct pubname_struct
*pubname_ref
;
3796 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct
*dw_ranges_ref
;
3797 typedef struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct
*dw_ranges_by_label_ref
;
3799 /* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
3800 line number associated with the label generated for that
3801 entry. The label gives the PC value associated with
3802 the line number entry. */
3804 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct
GTY(())
3806 unsigned long dw_file_num
;
3807 unsigned long dw_line_num
;
3811 /* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
3813 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct
GTY(())
3815 unsigned long dw_file_num
;
3816 unsigned long dw_line_num
;
3817 unsigned long function
;
3819 dw_separate_line_info_entry
;
3821 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
3822 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
3823 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
3825 typedef struct dw_attr_struct
GTY(())
3827 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr
;
3828 dw_val_node dw_attr_val
;
3832 DEF_VEC_O(dw_attr_node
);
3833 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dw_attr_node
,gc
);
3835 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure. DIEs form a tree.
3836 The children of each node form a circular list linked by
3837 die_sib. die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node. */
3839 typedef struct die_struct
GTY(())
3841 enum dwarf_tag die_tag
;
3843 VEC(dw_attr_node
,gc
) * die_attr
;
3844 dw_die_ref die_parent
;
3845 dw_die_ref die_child
;
3847 dw_die_ref die_definition
; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
3848 dw_offset die_offset
;
3849 unsigned long die_abbrev
;
3851 /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused. */
3852 int die_perennial_p
;
3853 unsigned int decl_id
;
3857 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order. */
3858 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do { \
3859 c = die->die_child; \
3863 } while (c != die->die_child); \
3866 /* The pubname structure */
3868 typedef struct pubname_struct
GTY(())
3875 DEF_VEC_O(pubname_entry
);
3876 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(pubname_entry
, gc
);
3878 struct dw_ranges_struct
GTY(())
3880 /* If this is positive, it's a block number, otherwise it's a
3881 bitwise-negated index into dw_ranges_by_label. */
3885 struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct
GTY(())
3891 /* The limbo die list structure. */
3892 typedef struct limbo_die_struct
GTY(())
3896 struct limbo_die_struct
*next
;
3900 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
3901 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
3902 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
3905 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3906 implicitly generated for a tagged type.
3908 Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
3909 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
3910 each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
3911 _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3912 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3913 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. */
3915 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
3916 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
3917 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
3918 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)) \
3919 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
3920 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
3921 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
3922 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
3923 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
3924 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3926 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3927 language, and compiler version. */
3929 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
3930 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3931 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
3933 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
3934 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3936 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
3937 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
3938 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3939 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3940 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
3942 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
3943 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
3944 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3945 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3946 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3947 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3949 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
3950 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3951 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3952 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3954 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3958 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3959 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
3960 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
3962 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
3963 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE 10
3965 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
3966 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3968 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3969 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3970 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3971 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
3972 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3974 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3975 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3976 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
3977 static unsigned long next_die_offset
;
3980 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3981 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref comp_unit_die
;
3983 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
3984 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node
*limbo_die_list
;
3986 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
3987 static GTY((param_is (struct dwarf_file_data
))) htab_t file_table
;
3989 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
3990 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
3991 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct
))) htab_t decl_die_table
;
3993 /* Node of the variable location list. */
3994 struct var_loc_node
GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next")))
3996 rtx
GTY (()) var_loc_note
;
3997 const char * GTY (()) label
;
3998 const char * GTY (()) section_label
;
3999 struct var_loc_node
* GTY (()) next
;
4002 /* Variable location list. */
4003 struct var_loc_list_def
GTY (())
4005 struct var_loc_node
* GTY (()) first
;
4007 /* Do not mark the last element of the chained list because
4008 it is marked through the chain. */
4009 struct var_loc_node
* GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last
;
4011 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
4012 unsigned int decl_id
;
4014 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list
;
4017 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
4018 static GTY ((param_is (var_loc_list
))) htab_t decl_loc_table
;
4020 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
4021 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
4022 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
4023 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
4024 dw_die_ref
*abbrev_die_table
;
4026 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
4027 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated
;
4029 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
4030 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use
;
4032 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
4033 abbrev_die_table. */
4034 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
4036 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
4037 for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit. */
4038 static GTY((length ("line_info_table_allocated")))
4039 dw_line_info_ref line_info_table
;
4041 /* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table. */
4042 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_allocated
;
4044 /* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use. */
4045 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_in_use
;
4047 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
4048 for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit. */
4049 static GTY ((length ("separate_line_info_table_allocated")))
4050 dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table
;
4052 /* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table. */
4053 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated
;
4055 /* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use. */
4056 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use
;
4058 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
4060 #define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
4062 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
4063 accessible names. */
4064 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry
, gc
) * pubname_table
;
4066 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
4067 accessible types. */
4068 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry
, gc
) * pubtype_table
;
4070 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info. */
4071 static GTY((length ("arange_table_allocated"))) dw_die_ref
*arange_table
;
4073 /* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table. */
4074 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_allocated
;
4076 /* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use. */
4077 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_in_use
;
4079 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
4081 #define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
4083 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
4084 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table
;
4086 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
4087 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated
;
4089 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
4090 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use
;
4092 /* Array of pairs of labels referenced in ranges_table. */
4093 static GTY ((length ("ranges_by_label_allocated")))
4094 dw_ranges_by_label_ref ranges_by_label
;
4096 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_by_label. */
4097 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_allocated
;
4099 /* Number of elements in ranges_by_label currently in use. */
4100 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_in_use
;
4102 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
4104 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
4106 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
4107 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists
;
4109 /* Unique label counter. */
4110 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num
;
4112 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4113 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions. */
4114 static int current_function_has_inlines
;
4116 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
4117 static int comp_unit_has_inlines
;
4120 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file(). */
4121 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data
* last_emitted_file
;
4123 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
4124 static GTY(()) int label_num
;
4126 /* Cached result of previous call to lookup_filename. */
4127 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data
* file_table_last_lookup
;
4129 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4131 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
4132 within the current function. */
4133 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset
;
4135 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
4137 static int is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx
);
4138 static tree
type_main_variant (tree
);
4139 static int is_tagged_type (const_tree
);
4140 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
4141 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
4142 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
4143 static tree
decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree
);
4144 static tree
block_ultimate_origin (const_tree
);
4145 static tree
decl_class_context (tree
);
4146 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref
, dw_attr_ref
);
4147 static inline enum dw_val_class
AT_class (dw_attr_ref
);
4148 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
, unsigned);
4149 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref
);
4150 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
, HOST_WIDE_INT
);
4151 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
AT_int (dw_attr_ref
);
4152 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
);
4153 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref
);
4154 static void add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
, unsigned long,
4156 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
, unsigned int,
4157 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
4158 static hashval_t
debug_str_do_hash (const void *);
4159 static int debug_str_eq (const void *, const void *);
4160 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
, const char *);
4161 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref
);
4162 static int AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref
);
4163 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
, dw_die_ref
);
4164 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref
, dw_die_ref
);
4165 static inline dw_die_ref
AT_ref (dw_attr_ref
);
4166 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref
);
4167 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref
, int);
4168 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
, unsigned);
4169 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
, dw_loc_descr_ref
);
4170 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
AT_loc (dw_attr_ref
);
4171 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
,
4173 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref
);
4174 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
, rtx
);
4175 static inline rtx
AT_addr (dw_attr_ref
);
4176 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
, const char *);
4177 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
, const char *);
4178 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
, const char *);
4179 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
,
4180 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
);
4181 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
,
4183 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref
);
4184 static dw_attr_ref
get_AT (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
);
4185 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref
);
4186 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref
);
4187 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
);
4188 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
);
4189 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
);
4190 static inline dw_die_ref
get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
);
4191 static bool is_c_family (void);
4192 static bool is_cxx (void);
4193 static bool is_java (void);
4194 static bool is_fortran (void);
4195 static bool is_ada (void);
4196 static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
);
4197 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_tag
);
4198 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref
, dw_die_ref
);
4199 static dw_die_ref
new_die (enum dwarf_tag
, dw_die_ref
, tree
);
4200 static dw_die_ref
lookup_type_die (tree
);
4201 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4202 static hashval_t
decl_die_table_hash (const void *);
4203 static int decl_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4204 static dw_die_ref
lookup_decl_die (tree
);
4205 static hashval_t
decl_loc_table_hash (const void *);
4206 static int decl_loc_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4207 static var_loc_list
*lookup_decl_loc (const_tree
);
4208 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4209 static void add_var_loc_to_decl (tree
, struct var_loc_node
*);
4210 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
4211 static void print_die (dw_die_ref
, FILE *);
4212 static void print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *);
4213 static dw_die_ref
push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref
, dw_die_ref
);
4214 static dw_die_ref
pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref
);
4215 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref
, struct md5_ctx
*);
4216 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref
, struct md5_ctx
*, int *);
4217 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref
, struct md5_ctx
*, int *);
4218 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref
, dw_loc_descr_ref
, int *);
4219 static int same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node
*, const dw_val_node
*, int *);
4220 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref
, dw_attr_ref
, int *);
4221 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref
, dw_die_ref
, int *);
4222 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref
, dw_die_ref
);
4223 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref
);
4224 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref
);
4225 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref
);
4226 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref
);
4227 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref
);
4228 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref
);
4229 static hashval_t
htab_cu_hash (const void *);
4230 static int htab_cu_eq (const void *, const void *);
4231 static void htab_cu_del (void *);
4232 static int check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref
, htab_t
, unsigned *);
4233 static void record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref
, htab_t
, unsigned);
4234 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref
);
4235 static void build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref
);
4236 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref
);
4237 static int constant_size (long unsigned);
4238 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref
);
4239 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref
);
4240 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref
);
4241 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref
);
4242 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref
);
4243 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry
,gc
) *);
4244 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
4245 static enum dwarf_form
value_format (dw_attr_ref
);
4246 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref
);
4247 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
4248 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref
);
4249 static void output_die (dw_die_ref
);
4250 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
4251 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref
, int);
4252 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree
, int);
4253 static void add_pubname (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4254 static void add_pubtype (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4255 static void output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry
,gc
) *);
4256 static void add_arange (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4257 static void output_aranges (void);
4258 static unsigned int add_ranges_num (int);
4259 static unsigned int add_ranges (const_tree
);
4260 static unsigned int add_ranges_by_labels (const char *, const char *);
4261 static void output_ranges (void);
4262 static void output_line_info (void);
4263 static void output_file_names (void);
4264 static dw_die_ref
base_type_die (tree
);
4265 static int is_base_type (tree
);
4266 static bool is_subrange_type (const_tree
);
4267 static dw_die_ref
subrange_type_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4268 static dw_die_ref
modified_type_die (tree
, int, int, dw_die_ref
);
4269 static int type_is_enum (const_tree
);
4270 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (const_rtx
);
4271 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref
*, int);
4272 static dw_loc_descr_ref
reg_loc_descriptor (rtx
, enum var_init_status
);
4273 static dw_loc_descr_ref
one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int,
4274 enum var_init_status
);
4275 static dw_loc_descr_ref
multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx
, rtx
,
4276 enum var_init_status
);
4277 static dw_loc_descr_ref
int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT
);
4278 static dw_loc_descr_ref
based_loc_descr (rtx
, HOST_WIDE_INT
,
4279 enum var_init_status
);
4280 static int is_based_loc (const_rtx
);
4281 static dw_loc_descr_ref
mem_loc_descriptor (rtx
, enum machine_mode mode
,
4282 enum var_init_status
);
4283 static dw_loc_descr_ref
concat_loc_descriptor (rtx
, rtx
,
4284 enum var_init_status
);
4285 static dw_loc_descr_ref
loc_descriptor (rtx
, enum var_init_status
);
4286 static dw_loc_descr_ref
loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree
, int);
4287 static dw_loc_descr_ref
loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree
);
4288 static HOST_WIDE_INT
ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT
, unsigned int);
4289 static tree
field_type (const_tree
);
4290 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree
);
4291 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree
);
4292 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree
);
4293 static HOST_WIDE_INT
field_byte_offset (const_tree
);
4294 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
,
4296 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref
, tree
);
4297 static void add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref
, rtx
);
4298 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT
, unsigned, unsigned char *);
4299 static HOST_WIDE_INT
extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
4300 static void insert_float (const_rtx
, unsigned char *);
4301 static rtx
rtl_for_decl_location (tree
);
4302 static void add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref
, tree
,
4303 enum dwarf_attribute
);
4304 static void tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref
, tree
);
4305 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref
, const char *);
4306 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref
);
4307 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref
, enum dwarf_attribute
, tree
);
4308 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref
, tree
);
4309 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref
, tree
);
4310 static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref
, tree
);
4311 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref
, tree
);
4312 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref
, tree
);
4313 static void add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref
, tree
);
4314 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref
, tree
);
4315 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref
, tree
);
4316 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref
, tree
);
4317 static void push_decl_scope (tree
);
4318 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
4319 static dw_die_ref
scope_die_for (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4320 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref
);
4321 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref
);
4322 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref
, tree
, int, int, dw_die_ref
);
4323 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref
, tree
);
4324 static const char *type_tag (const_tree
);
4325 static tree
member_declared_type (const_tree
);
4327 static const char *decl_start_label (tree
);
4329 static void gen_array_type_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4330 static void gen_descr_array_type_die (tree
, struct array_descr_info
*, dw_die_ref
);
4332 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4334 static void gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4335 static void gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4336 static void gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4337 static dw_die_ref
gen_enumeration_type_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4338 static dw_die_ref
gen_formal_parameter_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4339 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4340 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4341 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4342 static void gen_variable_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4343 static void gen_label_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4344 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
, int);
4345 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
, int);
4346 static void gen_field_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4347 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4348 static dw_die_ref
gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
4349 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree
, tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4350 static void gen_member_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4351 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
,
4352 enum debug_info_usage
);
4353 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4354 static void gen_typedef_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4355 static void gen_type_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4356 static void gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4357 static void gen_block_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
, int);
4358 static void decls_for_scope (tree
, dw_die_ref
, int);
4359 static int is_redundant_typedef (const_tree
);
4360 static void gen_namespace_die (tree
);
4361 static void gen_decl_die (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4362 static dw_die_ref
force_decl_die (tree
);
4363 static dw_die_ref
force_type_die (tree
);
4364 static dw_die_ref
setup_namespace_context (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4365 static void declare_in_namespace (tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4366 static struct dwarf_file_data
* lookup_filename (const char *);
4367 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
4368 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree
, tree
, dw_die_ref
);
4369 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref
, dw_die_ref
);
4370 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
4371 static dw_loc_list_ref
new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref
, const char *,
4372 const char *, const char *, unsigned);
4373 static void add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref
*, dw_loc_descr_ref
,
4374 const char *, const char *,
4376 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref
);
4377 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
4379 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref
);
4380 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref
, int);
4381 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref
);
4382 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref
);
4383 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref
);
4384 static void prune_unused_types (void);
4385 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data
*fd
);
4387 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
4388 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
4389 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
4391 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
4392 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
4394 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
4395 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
4397 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
4398 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
4400 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
4401 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
4403 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
4404 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
4406 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
4407 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION ".debug_pubnames"
4409 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
4410 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
4412 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
4413 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
4416 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
4417 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
4418 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
4421 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
4422 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
4423 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_debug_strings \
4424 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
4427 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
4428 the section names themselves. */
4430 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4431 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
4433 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4434 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
4436 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
4437 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
4439 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
4440 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
4442 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
4443 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
4445 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
4446 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
4448 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
4449 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
4451 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
4452 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
4455 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
4456 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
4457 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
4458 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
4459 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
4461 static char text_end_label
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
4462 static char text_section_label
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
4463 static char cold_text_section_label
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
4464 static char cold_end_label
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
4465 static char abbrev_section_label
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
4466 static char debug_info_section_label
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
4467 static char debug_line_section_label
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
4468 static char macinfo_section_label
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
4469 static char loc_section_label
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
4470 static char ranges_section_label
[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
4472 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
4473 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
4475 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
4476 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
4478 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
4479 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
4481 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
4482 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
4484 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
4485 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
4487 #ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
4488 #define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL "LSM"
4492 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
4493 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
4495 static const char *(*demangle_name_func
) (const char *);
4498 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func
) (const char *))
4500 demangle_name_func
= func
;
4503 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
4506 is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx rtl
)
4508 return ((REG_P (rtl
) && REGNO (rtl
) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
4509 || (GET_CODE (rtl
) == SUBREG
4510 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl
)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
));
4513 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
4517 type_main_variant (tree type
)
4519 type
= TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type
);
4521 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
4522 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
4523 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
4524 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
4526 if (TREE_CODE (type
) == ARRAY_TYPE
)
4527 while (type
!= TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type
))
4528 type
= TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type
);
4533 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
4536 is_tagged_type (const_tree type
)
4538 enum tree_code code
= TREE_CODE (type
);
4540 return (code
== RECORD_TYPE
|| code
== UNION_TYPE
4541 || code
== QUAL_UNION_TYPE
|| code
== ENUMERAL_TYPE
);
4544 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
4547 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag
)
4551 case DW_TAG_padding
:
4552 return "DW_TAG_padding";
4553 case DW_TAG_array_type
:
4554 return "DW_TAG_array_type";
4555 case DW_TAG_class_type
:
4556 return "DW_TAG_class_type";
4557 case DW_TAG_entry_point
:
4558 return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
4559 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type
:
4560 return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
4561 case DW_TAG_formal_parameter
:
4562 return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
4563 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration
:
4564 return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
4566 return "DW_TAG_label";
4567 case DW_TAG_lexical_block
:
4568 return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
4570 return "DW_TAG_member";
4571 case DW_TAG_pointer_type
:
4572 return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
4573 case DW_TAG_reference_type
:
4574 return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
4575 case DW_TAG_compile_unit
:
4576 return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
4577 case DW_TAG_string_type
:
4578 return "DW_TAG_string_type";
4579 case DW_TAG_structure_type
:
4580 return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
4581 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type
:
4582 return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
4583 case DW_TAG_typedef
:
4584 return "DW_TAG_typedef";
4585 case DW_TAG_union_type
:
4586 return "DW_TAG_union_type";
4587 case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters
:
4588 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
4589 case DW_TAG_variant
:
4590 return "DW_TAG_variant";
4591 case DW_TAG_common_block
:
4592 return "DW_TAG_common_block";
4593 case DW_TAG_common_inclusion
:
4594 return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
4595 case DW_TAG_inheritance
:
4596 return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
4597 case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
:
4598 return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
4600 return "DW_TAG_module";
4601 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type
:
4602 return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
4603 case DW_TAG_set_type
:
4604 return "DW_TAG_set_type";
4605 case DW_TAG_subrange_type
:
4606 return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
4607 case DW_TAG_with_stmt
:
4608 return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
4609 case DW_TAG_access_declaration
:
4610 return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
4611 case DW_TAG_base_type
:
4612 return "DW_TAG_base_type";
4613 case DW_TAG_catch_block
:
4614 return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
4615 case DW_TAG_const_type
:
4616 return "DW_TAG_const_type";
4617 case DW_TAG_constant
:
4618 return "DW_TAG_constant";
4619 case DW_TAG_enumerator
:
4620 return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
4621 case DW_TAG_file_type
:
4622 return "DW_TAG_file_type";
4624 return "DW_TAG_friend";
4625 case DW_TAG_namelist
:
4626 return "DW_TAG_namelist";
4627 case DW_TAG_namelist_item
:
4628 return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
4629 case DW_TAG_packed_type
:
4630 return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
4631 case DW_TAG_subprogram
:
4632 return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
4633 case DW_TAG_template_type_param
:
4634 return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
4635 case DW_TAG_template_value_param
:
4636 return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
4637 case DW_TAG_thrown_type
:
4638 return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
4639 case DW_TAG_try_block
:
4640 return "DW_TAG_try_block";
4641 case DW_TAG_variant_part
:
4642 return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
4643 case DW_TAG_variable
:
4644 return "DW_TAG_variable";
4645 case DW_TAG_volatile_type
:
4646 return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
4647 case DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure
:
4648 return "DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure";
4649 case DW_TAG_restrict_type
:
4650 return "DW_TAG_restrict_type";
4651 case DW_TAG_interface_type
:
4652 return "DW_TAG_interface_type";
4653 case DW_TAG_namespace
:
4654 return "DW_TAG_namespace";
4655 case DW_TAG_imported_module
:
4656 return "DW_TAG_imported_module";
4657 case DW_TAG_unspecified_type
:
4658 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_type";
4659 case DW_TAG_partial_unit
:
4660 return "DW_TAG_partial_unit";
4661 case DW_TAG_imported_unit
:
4662 return "DW_TAG_imported_unit";
4663 case DW_TAG_condition
:
4664 return "DW_TAG_condition";
4665 case DW_TAG_shared_type
:
4666 return "DW_TAG_shared_type";
4667 case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop
:
4668 return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
4669 case DW_TAG_format_label
:
4670 return "DW_TAG_format_label";
4671 case DW_TAG_function_template
:
4672 return "DW_TAG_function_template";
4673 case DW_TAG_class_template
:
4674 return "DW_TAG_class_template";
4675 case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
:
4676 return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
4677 case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
:
4678 return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
4680 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
4684 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
4687 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr
)
4692 return "DW_AT_sibling";
4693 case DW_AT_location
:
4694 return "DW_AT_location";
4696 return "DW_AT_name";
4697 case DW_AT_ordering
:
4698 return "DW_AT_ordering";
4699 case DW_AT_subscr_data
:
4700 return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
4701 case DW_AT_byte_size
:
4702 return "DW_AT_byte_size";
4703 case DW_AT_bit_offset
:
4704 return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
4705 case DW_AT_bit_size
:
4706 return "DW_AT_bit_size";
4707 case DW_AT_element_list
:
4708 return "DW_AT_element_list";
4709 case DW_AT_stmt_list
:
4710 return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
4712 return "DW_AT_low_pc";
4714 return "DW_AT_high_pc";
4715 case DW_AT_language
:
4716 return "DW_AT_language";
4718 return "DW_AT_member";
4720 return "DW_AT_discr";
4721 case DW_AT_discr_value
:
4722 return "DW_AT_discr_value";
4723 case DW_AT_visibility
:
4724 return "DW_AT_visibility";
4726 return "DW_AT_import";
4727 case DW_AT_string_length
:
4728 return "DW_AT_string_length";
4729 case DW_AT_common_reference
:
4730 return "DW_AT_common_reference";
4731 case DW_AT_comp_dir
:
4732 return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
4733 case DW_AT_const_value
:
4734 return "DW_AT_const_value";
4735 case DW_AT_containing_type
:
4736 return "DW_AT_containing_type";
4737 case DW_AT_default_value
:
4738 return "DW_AT_default_value";
4740 return "DW_AT_inline";
4741 case DW_AT_is_optional
:
4742 return "DW_AT_is_optional";
4743 case DW_AT_lower_bound
:
4744 return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
4745 case DW_AT_producer
:
4746 return "DW_AT_producer";
4747 case DW_AT_prototyped
:
4748 return "DW_AT_prototyped";
4749 case DW_AT_return_addr
:
4750 return "DW_AT_return_addr";
4751 case DW_AT_start_scope
:
4752 return "DW_AT_start_scope";
4753 case DW_AT_bit_stride
:
4754 return "DW_AT_bit_stride";
4755 case DW_AT_upper_bound
:
4756 return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
4757 case DW_AT_abstract_origin
:
4758 return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
4759 case DW_AT_accessibility
:
4760 return "DW_AT_accessibility";
4761 case DW_AT_address_class
:
4762 return "DW_AT_address_class";
4763 case DW_AT_artificial
:
4764 return "DW_AT_artificial";
4765 case DW_AT_base_types
:
4766 return "DW_AT_base_types";
4767 case DW_AT_calling_convention
:
4768 return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
4770 return "DW_AT_count";
4771 case DW_AT_data_member_location
:
4772 return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
4773 case DW_AT_decl_column
:
4774 return "DW_AT_decl_column";
4775 case DW_AT_decl_file
:
4776 return "DW_AT_decl_file";
4777 case DW_AT_decl_line
:
4778 return "DW_AT_decl_line";
4779 case DW_AT_declaration
:
4780 return "DW_AT_declaration";
4781 case DW_AT_discr_list
:
4782 return "DW_AT_discr_list";
4783 case DW_AT_encoding
:
4784 return "DW_AT_encoding";
4785 case DW_AT_external
:
4786 return "DW_AT_external";
4787 case DW_AT_frame_base
:
4788 return "DW_AT_frame_base";
4790 return "DW_AT_friend";
4791 case DW_AT_identifier_case
:
4792 return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
4793 case DW_AT_macro_info
:
4794 return "DW_AT_macro_info";
4795 case DW_AT_namelist_items
:
4796 return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
4797 case DW_AT_priority
:
4798 return "DW_AT_priority";
4800 return "DW_AT_segment";
4801 case DW_AT_specification
:
4802 return "DW_AT_specification";
4803 case DW_AT_static_link
:
4804 return "DW_AT_static_link";
4806 return "DW_AT_type";
4807 case DW_AT_use_location
:
4808 return "DW_AT_use_location";
4809 case DW_AT_variable_parameter
:
4810 return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
4811 case DW_AT_virtuality
:
4812 return "DW_AT_virtuality";
4813 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location
:
4814 return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
4816 case DW_AT_allocated
:
4817 return "DW_AT_allocated";
4818 case DW_AT_associated
:
4819 return "DW_AT_associated";
4820 case DW_AT_data_location
:
4821 return "DW_AT_data_location";
4822 case DW_AT_byte_stride
:
4823 return "DW_AT_byte_stride";
4824 case DW_AT_entry_pc
:
4825 return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
4826 case DW_AT_use_UTF8
:
4827 return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
4828 case DW_AT_extension
:
4829 return "DW_AT_extension";
4831 return "DW_AT_ranges";
4832 case DW_AT_trampoline
:
4833 return "DW_AT_trampoline";
4834 case DW_AT_call_column
:
4835 return "DW_AT_call_column";
4836 case DW_AT_call_file
:
4837 return "DW_AT_call_file";
4838 case DW_AT_call_line
:
4839 return "DW_AT_call_line";
4841 case DW_AT_MIPS_fde
:
4842 return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
4843 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin
:
4844 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
4845 case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin
:
4846 return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
4847 case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin
:
4848 return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
4849 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor
:
4850 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4851 case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth
:
4852 return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
4853 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name
:
4854 return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
4855 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride
:
4856 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4857 case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name
:
4858 return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
4859 case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin
:
4860 return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
4861 case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines
:
4862 return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
4864 case DW_AT_sf_names
:
4865 return "DW_AT_sf_names";
4866 case DW_AT_src_info
:
4867 return "DW_AT_src_info";
4868 case DW_AT_mac_info
:
4869 return "DW_AT_mac_info";
4870 case DW_AT_src_coords
:
4871 return "DW_AT_src_coords";
4872 case DW_AT_body_begin
:
4873 return "DW_AT_body_begin";
4874 case DW_AT_body_end
:
4875 return "DW_AT_body_end";
4876 case DW_AT_GNU_vector
:
4877 return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
4879 case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address
:
4880 return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
4883 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4887 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
4890 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form
)
4895 return "DW_FORM_addr";
4896 case DW_FORM_block2
:
4897 return "DW_FORM_block2";
4898 case DW_FORM_block4
:
4899 return "DW_FORM_block4";
4901 return "DW_FORM_data2";
4903 return "DW_FORM_data4";
4905 return "DW_FORM_data8";
4906 case DW_FORM_string
:
4907 return "DW_FORM_string";
4909 return "DW_FORM_block";
4910 case DW_FORM_block1
:
4911 return "DW_FORM_block1";
4913 return "DW_FORM_data1";
4915 return "DW_FORM_flag";
4917 return "DW_FORM_sdata";
4919 return "DW_FORM_strp";
4921 return "DW_FORM_udata";
4922 case DW_FORM_ref_addr
:
4923 return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
4925 return "DW_FORM_ref1";
4927 return "DW_FORM_ref2";
4929 return "DW_FORM_ref4";
4931 return "DW_FORM_ref8";
4932 case DW_FORM_ref_udata
:
4933 return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
4934 case DW_FORM_indirect
:
4935 return "DW_FORM_indirect";
4937 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4941 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
4942 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4943 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4944 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4948 decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree decl
)
4950 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl
), TS_DECL_COMMON
))
4953 /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4954 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4955 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4956 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl
) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl
) == decl
)
4959 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4960 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
4961 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl
)));
4963 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl
);
4966 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a block. The block may be an inlined
4967 instance of an inlined instance of a block which is local to an inline
4968 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4969 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4973 block_ultimate_origin (const_tree block
)
4975 tree immediate_origin
= BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (block
);
4977 /* output_inline_function sets BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4978 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4979 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4980 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (block
) && immediate_origin
== block
)
4983 if (immediate_origin
== NULL_TREE
)
4988 tree lookahead
= immediate_origin
;
4992 ret_val
= lookahead
;
4993 lookahead
= (TREE_CODE (ret_val
) == BLOCK
4994 ? BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (ret_val
) : NULL
);
4996 while (lookahead
!= NULL
&& lookahead
!= ret_val
);
4998 /* The block's abstract origin chain may not be the *ultimate* origin of
4999 the block. It could lead to a DECL that has an abstract origin set.
5000 If so, we want that DECL's abstract origin (which is what DECL_ORIGIN
5001 will give us if it has one). Note that DECL's abstract origins are
5002 supposed to be the most distant ancestor (or so decl_ultimate_origin
5003 claims), so we don't need to loop following the DECL origins. */
5004 if (DECL_P (ret_val
))
5005 return DECL_ORIGIN (ret_val
);
5011 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
5012 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
5016 decl_class_context (tree decl
)
5018 tree context
= NULL_TREE
;
5020 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) != FUNCTION_DECL
|| ! DECL_VINDEX (decl
))
5021 context
= DECL_CONTEXT (decl
);
5023 context
= TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
5024 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl
)))));
5026 if (context
&& !TYPE_P (context
))
5027 context
= NULL_TREE
;
5032 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. */
5035 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die
, dw_attr_ref attr
)
5037 /* Maybe this should be an assert? */
5041 if (die
->die_attr
== NULL
)
5042 die
->die_attr
= VEC_alloc (dw_attr_node
, gc
, 1);
5043 VEC_safe_push (dw_attr_node
, gc
, die
->die_attr
, attr
);
5046 static inline enum dw_val_class
5047 AT_class (dw_attr_ref a
)
5049 return a
->dw_attr_val
.val_class
;
5052 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
5055 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
, unsigned int flag
)
5059 attr
.dw_attr
= attr_kind
;
5060 attr
.dw_attr_val
.val_class
= dw_val_class_flag
;
5061 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_flag
= flag
;
5062 add_dwarf_attr (die
, &attr
);
5065 static inline unsigned
5066 AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a
)
5068 gcc_assert (a
&& AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_flag
);
5069 return a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_flag
;
5072 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
5075 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val
)
5079 attr
.dw_attr
= attr_kind
;
5080 attr
.dw_attr_val
.val_class
= dw_val_class_const
;
5081 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_int
= int_val
;
5082 add_dwarf_attr (die
, &attr
);
5085 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
5086 AT_int (dw_attr_ref a
)
5088 gcc_assert (a
&& AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_const
);
5089 return a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_int
;
5092 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
5095 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
,
5096 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val
)
5100 attr
.dw_attr
= attr_kind
;
5101 attr
.dw_attr_val
.val_class
= dw_val_class_unsigned_const
;
5102 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_unsigned
= unsigned_val
;
5103 add_dwarf_attr (die
, &attr
);
5106 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
5107 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a
)
5109 gcc_assert (a
&& AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const
);
5110 return a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_unsigned
;
5113 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
5116 add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
,
5117 long unsigned int val_hi
, long unsigned int val_low
)
5121 attr
.dw_attr
= attr_kind
;
5122 attr
.dw_attr_val
.val_class
= dw_val_class_long_long
;
5123 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_long_long
.hi
= val_hi
;
5124 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_long_long
.low
= val_low
;
5125 add_dwarf_attr (die
, &attr
);
5128 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
5131 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
,
5132 unsigned int length
, unsigned int elt_size
, unsigned char *array
)
5136 attr
.dw_attr
= attr_kind
;
5137 attr
.dw_attr_val
.val_class
= dw_val_class_vec
;
5138 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_vec
.length
= length
;
5139 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_vec
.elt_size
= elt_size
;
5140 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_vec
.array
= array
;
5141 add_dwarf_attr (die
, &attr
);
5144 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
5147 debug_str_do_hash (const void *x
)
5149 return htab_hash_string (((const struct indirect_string_node
*)x
)->str
);
5153 debug_str_eq (const void *x1
, const void *x2
)
5155 return strcmp ((((const struct indirect_string_node
*)x1
)->str
),
5156 (const char *)x2
) == 0;
5159 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
5162 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
, const char *str
)
5165 struct indirect_string_node
*node
;
5168 if (! debug_str_hash
)
5169 debug_str_hash
= htab_create_ggc (10, debug_str_do_hash
,
5170 debug_str_eq
, NULL
);
5172 slot
= htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash
, str
,
5173 htab_hash_string (str
), INSERT
);
5176 node
= (struct indirect_string_node
*)
5177 ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct indirect_string_node
));
5178 node
->str
= ggc_strdup (str
);
5182 node
= (struct indirect_string_node
*) *slot
;
5186 attr
.dw_attr
= attr_kind
;
5187 attr
.dw_attr_val
.val_class
= dw_val_class_str
;
5188 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_str
= node
;
5189 add_dwarf_attr (die
, &attr
);
5192 static inline const char *
5193 AT_string (dw_attr_ref a
)
5195 gcc_assert (a
&& AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_str
);
5196 return a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_str
->str
;
5199 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
5200 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
5203 AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a
)
5205 struct indirect_string_node
*node
;
5209 gcc_assert (a
&& AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_str
);
5211 node
= a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_str
;
5215 len
= strlen (node
->str
) + 1;
5217 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
5218 always better to put it inline. */
5219 if (len
<= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
|| node
->refcount
== 0)
5220 return node
->form
= DW_FORM_string
;
5222 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
5223 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
5225 if ((debug_str_section
->common
.flags
& SECTION_MERGE
) == 0
5226 && (len
- DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
) * node
->refcount
<= len
)
5227 return node
->form
= DW_FORM_string
;
5229 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label
, "LASF", dw2_string_counter
);
5230 ++dw2_string_counter
;
5231 node
->label
= xstrdup (label
);
5233 return node
->form
= DW_FORM_strp
;
5236 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
5239 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
, dw_die_ref targ_die
)
5243 attr
.dw_attr
= attr_kind
;
5244 attr
.dw_attr_val
.val_class
= dw_val_class_die_ref
;
5245 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_die_ref
.die
= targ_die
;
5246 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_die_ref
.external
= 0;
5247 add_dwarf_attr (die
, &attr
);
5250 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
5251 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
5254 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die
, dw_die_ref targ_die
)
5256 add_AT_die_ref (die
, DW_AT_specification
, targ_die
);
5257 gcc_assert (!targ_die
->die_definition
);
5258 targ_die
->die_definition
= die
;
5261 static inline dw_die_ref
5262 AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a
)
5264 gcc_assert (a
&& AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_die_ref
);
5265 return a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_die_ref
.die
;
5269 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a
)
5271 if (a
&& AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_die_ref
)
5272 return a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_die_ref
.external
;
5278 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a
, int i
)
5280 gcc_assert (a
&& AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_die_ref
);
5281 a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_die_ref
.external
= i
;
5284 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
5287 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
, unsigned int targ_fde
)
5291 attr
.dw_attr
= attr_kind
;
5292 attr
.dw_attr_val
.val_class
= dw_val_class_fde_ref
;
5293 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_fde_index
= targ_fde
;
5294 add_dwarf_attr (die
, &attr
);
5297 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
5300 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
, dw_loc_descr_ref loc
)
5304 attr
.dw_attr
= attr_kind
;
5305 attr
.dw_attr_val
.val_class
= dw_val_class_loc
;
5306 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_loc
= loc
;
5307 add_dwarf_attr (die
, &attr
);
5310 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
5311 AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a
)
5313 gcc_assert (a
&& AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_loc
);
5314 return a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_loc
;
5318 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list
)
5322 attr
.dw_attr
= attr_kind
;
5323 attr
.dw_attr_val
.val_class
= dw_val_class_loc_list
;
5324 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_loc_list
= loc_list
;
5325 add_dwarf_attr (die
, &attr
);
5326 have_location_lists
= true;
5329 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
5330 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a
)
5332 gcc_assert (a
&& AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_loc_list
);
5333 return a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_loc_list
;
5336 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. */
5339 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
, rtx addr
)
5343 attr
.dw_attr
= attr_kind
;
5344 attr
.dw_attr_val
.val_class
= dw_val_class_addr
;
5345 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_addr
= addr
;
5346 add_dwarf_attr (die
, &attr
);
5349 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute. */
5352 AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a
)
5354 gcc_assert (a
&& AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_addr
);
5355 return a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_addr
;
5358 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE. */
5361 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
,
5362 struct dwarf_file_data
*fd
)
5366 attr
.dw_attr
= attr_kind
;
5367 attr
.dw_attr_val
.val_class
= dw_val_class_file
;
5368 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_file
= fd
;
5369 add_dwarf_attr (die
, &attr
);
5372 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute. */
5374 static inline struct dwarf_file_data
*
5375 AT_file (dw_attr_ref a
)
5377 gcc_assert (a
&& AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_file
);
5378 return a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_file
;
5381 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
5384 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
, const char *lbl_id
)
5388 attr
.dw_attr
= attr_kind
;
5389 attr
.dw_attr_val
.val_class
= dw_val_class_lbl_id
;
5390 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_lbl_id
= xstrdup (lbl_id
);
5391 add_dwarf_attr (die
, &attr
);
5394 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5395 debug_line section. */
5398 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
,
5403 attr
.dw_attr
= attr_kind
;
5404 attr
.dw_attr_val
.val_class
= dw_val_class_lineptr
;
5405 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_lbl_id
= xstrdup (label
);
5406 add_dwarf_attr (die
, &attr
);
5409 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5410 debug_macinfo section. */
5413 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
,
5418 attr
.dw_attr
= attr_kind
;
5419 attr
.dw_attr_val
.val_class
= dw_val_class_macptr
;
5420 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_lbl_id
= xstrdup (label
);
5421 add_dwarf_attr (die
, &attr
);
5424 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
5427 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
,
5428 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset
)
5432 attr
.dw_attr
= attr_kind
;
5433 attr
.dw_attr_val
.val_class
= dw_val_class_offset
;
5434 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_offset
= offset
;
5435 add_dwarf_attr (die
, &attr
);
5438 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE. */
5441 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
,
5442 long unsigned int offset
)
5446 attr
.dw_attr
= attr_kind
;
5447 attr
.dw_attr_val
.val_class
= dw_val_class_range_list
;
5448 attr
.dw_attr_val
.v
.val_offset
= offset
;
5449 add_dwarf_attr (die
, &attr
);
5452 static inline const char *
5453 AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a
)
5455 gcc_assert (a
&& (AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
5456 || AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_lineptr
5457 || AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_macptr
));
5458 return a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_lbl_id
;
5461 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
5464 get_AT (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
)
5468 dw_die_ref spec
= NULL
;
5473 for (ix
= 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node
, die
->die_attr
, ix
, a
); ix
++)
5474 if (a
->dw_attr
== attr_kind
)
5476 else if (a
->dw_attr
== DW_AT_specification
5477 || a
->dw_attr
== DW_AT_abstract_origin
)
5481 return get_AT (spec
, attr_kind
);
5486 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5487 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5488 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5490 static inline const char *
5491 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die
)
5493 dw_attr_ref a
= get_AT (die
, DW_AT_low_pc
);
5495 return a
? AT_lbl (a
) : NULL
;
5498 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5499 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5500 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5502 static inline const char *
5503 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die
)
5505 dw_attr_ref a
= get_AT (die
, DW_AT_high_pc
);
5507 return a
? AT_lbl (a
) : NULL
;
5510 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
5511 NULL if it is not present. */
5513 static inline const char *
5514 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
)
5516 dw_attr_ref a
= get_AT (die
, attr_kind
);
5518 return a
? AT_string (a
) : NULL
;
5521 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
5522 if it is not present. */
5525 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
)
5527 dw_attr_ref a
= get_AT (die
, attr_kind
);
5529 return a
? AT_flag (a
) : 0;
5532 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
5533 if it is not present. */
5535 static inline unsigned
5536 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
)
5538 dw_attr_ref a
= get_AT (die
, attr_kind
);
5540 return a
? AT_unsigned (a
) : 0;
5543 static inline dw_die_ref
5544 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
)
5546 dw_attr_ref a
= get_AT (die
, attr_kind
);
5548 return a
? AT_ref (a
) : NULL
;
5551 static inline struct dwarf_file_data
*
5552 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
)
5554 dw_attr_ref a
= get_AT (die
, attr_kind
);
5556 return a
? AT_file (a
) : NULL
;
5559 /* Return TRUE if the language is C or C++. */
5564 unsigned int lang
= get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die
, DW_AT_language
);
5566 return (lang
== DW_LANG_C
|| lang
== DW_LANG_C89
|| lang
== DW_LANG_ObjC
5567 || lang
== DW_LANG_C99
5568 || lang
== DW_LANG_C_plus_plus
|| lang
== DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus
);
5571 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
5576 unsigned int lang
= get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die
, DW_AT_language
);
5578 return lang
== DW_LANG_C_plus_plus
|| lang
== DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus
;
5581 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
5586 unsigned int lang
= get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die
, DW_AT_language
);
5588 return (lang
== DW_LANG_Fortran77
5589 || lang
== DW_LANG_Fortran90
5590 || lang
== DW_LANG_Fortran95
);
5593 /* Return TRUE if the language is Java. */
5598 unsigned int lang
= get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die
, DW_AT_language
);
5600 return lang
== DW_LANG_Java
;
5603 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
5608 unsigned int lang
= get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die
, DW_AT_language
);
5610 return lang
== DW_LANG_Ada95
|| lang
== DW_LANG_Ada83
;
5613 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
5616 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
)
5624 for (ix
= 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node
, die
->die_attr
, ix
, a
); ix
++)
5625 if (a
->dw_attr
== attr_kind
)
5627 if (AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_str
)
5628 if (a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_str
->refcount
)
5629 a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_str
->refcount
--;
5631 /* VEC_ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
5633 VEC_ordered_remove (dw_attr_node
, die
->die_attr
, ix
);
5638 /* Remove CHILD from its parent. PREV must have the property that
5639 PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD. Does not alter CHILD. */
5642 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child
, dw_die_ref prev
)
5644 gcc_assert (child
->die_parent
== prev
->die_parent
);
5645 gcc_assert (prev
->die_sib
== child
);
5648 gcc_assert (child
->die_parent
->die_child
== child
);
5652 prev
->die_sib
= child
->die_sib
;
5653 if (child
->die_parent
->die_child
== child
)
5654 child
->die_parent
->die_child
= prev
;
5657 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG. Do nothing if no child
5661 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_tag tag
)
5667 dw_die_ref prev
= c
;
5669 while (c
->die_tag
== tag
)
5671 remove_child_with_prev (c
, prev
);
5672 /* Might have removed every child. */
5673 if (c
== c
->die_sib
)
5677 } while (c
!= die
->die_child
);
5680 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE. */
5683 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die
, dw_die_ref child_die
)
5685 /* FIXME this should probably be an assert. */
5686 if (! die
|| ! child_die
)
5688 gcc_assert (die
!= child_die
);
5690 child_die
->die_parent
= die
;
5693 child_die
->die_sib
= die
->die_child
->die_sib
;
5694 die
->die_child
->die_sib
= child_die
;
5697 child_die
->die_sib
= child_die
;
5698 die
->die_child
= child_die
;
5701 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5702 is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
5703 This is done by removing and re-adding it. */
5706 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent
, dw_die_ref child
)
5710 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5711 specification DIE at toplevel. */
5712 if (child
->die_parent
!= parent
)
5714 dw_die_ref tmp
= get_AT_ref (child
, DW_AT_specification
);
5720 gcc_assert (child
->die_parent
== parent
5721 || (child
->die_parent
5722 == get_AT_ref (parent
, DW_AT_specification
)));
5724 for (p
= child
->die_parent
->die_child
; ; p
= p
->die_sib
)
5725 if (p
->die_sib
== child
)
5727 remove_child_with_prev (child
, p
);
5731 add_child_die (parent
, child
);
5734 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
5736 static inline dw_die_ref
5737 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value
, dw_die_ref parent_die
, tree t
)
5739 dw_die_ref die
= ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (die_node
));
5741 die
->die_tag
= tag_value
;
5743 if (parent_die
!= NULL
)
5744 add_child_die (parent_die
, die
);
5747 limbo_die_node
*limbo_node
;
5749 limbo_node
= ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (limbo_die_node
));
5750 limbo_node
->die
= die
;
5751 limbo_node
->created_for
= t
;
5752 limbo_node
->next
= limbo_die_list
;
5753 limbo_die_list
= limbo_node
;
5759 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
5761 static inline dw_die_ref
5762 lookup_type_die (tree type
)
5764 return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type
);
5767 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
5770 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type
, dw_die_ref type_die
)
5772 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type
) = type_die
;
5775 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
5778 decl_die_table_hash (const void *x
)
5780 return (hashval_t
) ((const_dw_die_ref
) x
)->decl_id
;
5783 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
5786 decl_die_table_eq (const void *x
, const void *y
)
5788 return (((const_dw_die_ref
) x
)->decl_id
== DECL_UID ((const_tree
) y
));
5791 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
5793 static inline dw_die_ref
5794 lookup_decl_die (tree decl
)
5796 return htab_find_with_hash (decl_die_table
, decl
, DECL_UID (decl
));
5799 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
5802 decl_loc_table_hash (const void *x
)
5804 return (hashval_t
) ((const var_loc_list
*) x
)->decl_id
;
5807 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
5811 decl_loc_table_eq (const void *x
, const void *y
)
5813 return (((const var_loc_list
*) x
)->decl_id
== DECL_UID ((const_tree
) y
));
5816 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
5818 static inline var_loc_list
*
5819 lookup_decl_loc (const_tree decl
)
5821 return htab_find_with_hash (decl_loc_table
, decl
, DECL_UID (decl
));
5824 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
5827 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl
, dw_die_ref decl_die
)
5829 unsigned int decl_id
= DECL_UID (decl
);
5832 slot
= htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_die_table
, decl
, decl_id
, INSERT
);
5834 decl_die
->decl_id
= decl_id
;
5837 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
5840 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl
, struct var_loc_node
*loc
)
5842 unsigned int decl_id
= DECL_UID (decl
);
5846 slot
= htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_loc_table
, decl
, decl_id
, INSERT
);
5849 temp
= ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (var_loc_list
));
5850 temp
->decl_id
= decl_id
;
5858 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
5859 and either both or neither of the locations is uninitialized,
5860 we have nothing to do. */
5861 if ((!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp
->last
->var_loc_note
),
5862 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc
->var_loc_note
)))
5863 || ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (temp
->last
->var_loc_note
)
5864 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc
->var_loc_note
))
5865 && ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (temp
->last
->var_loc_note
)
5866 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
)
5867 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc
->var_loc_note
)
5868 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
))))
5870 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. */
5871 temp
->last
->next
= loc
;
5875 /* Do not add empty location to the beginning of the list. */
5876 else if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc
->var_loc_note
) != NULL_RTX
)
5883 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
5884 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
5885 the DIE internal representation. */
5886 static int print_indent
;
5888 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
5891 print_spaces (FILE *outfile
)
5893 fprintf (outfile
, "%*s", print_indent
, "");
5896 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
5897 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5900 print_die (dw_die_ref die
, FILE *outfile
)
5906 print_spaces (outfile
);
5907 fprintf (outfile
, "DIE %4ld: %s\n",
5908 die
->die_offset
, dwarf_tag_name (die
->die_tag
));
5909 print_spaces (outfile
);
5910 fprintf (outfile
, " abbrev id: %lu", die
->die_abbrev
);
5911 fprintf (outfile
, " offset: %ld\n", die
->die_offset
);
5913 for (ix
= 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node
, die
->die_attr
, ix
, a
); ix
++)
5915 print_spaces (outfile
);
5916 fprintf (outfile
, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a
->dw_attr
));
5918 switch (AT_class (a
))
5920 case dw_val_class_addr
:
5921 fprintf (outfile
, "address");
5923 case dw_val_class_offset
:
5924 fprintf (outfile
, "offset");
5926 case dw_val_class_loc
:
5927 fprintf (outfile
, "location descriptor");
5929 case dw_val_class_loc_list
:
5930 fprintf (outfile
, "location list -> label:%s",
5931 AT_loc_list (a
)->ll_symbol
);
5933 case dw_val_class_range_list
:
5934 fprintf (outfile
, "range list");
5936 case dw_val_class_const
:
5937 fprintf (outfile
, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC
, AT_int (a
));
5939 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const
:
5940 fprintf (outfile
, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED
, AT_unsigned (a
));
5942 case dw_val_class_long_long
:
5943 fprintf (outfile
, "constant (%lu,%lu)",
5944 a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_long_long
.hi
,
5945 a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_long_long
.low
);
5947 case dw_val_class_vec
:
5948 fprintf (outfile
, "floating-point or vector constant");
5950 case dw_val_class_flag
:
5951 fprintf (outfile
, "%u", AT_flag (a
));
5953 case dw_val_class_die_ref
:
5954 if (AT_ref (a
) != NULL
)
5956 if (AT_ref (a
)->die_symbol
)
5957 fprintf (outfile
, "die -> label: %s", AT_ref (a
)->die_symbol
);
5959 fprintf (outfile
, "die -> %ld", AT_ref (a
)->die_offset
);
5962 fprintf (outfile
, "die -> <null>");
5964 case dw_val_class_lbl_id
:
5965 case dw_val_class_lineptr
:
5966 case dw_val_class_macptr
:
5967 fprintf (outfile
, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a
));
5969 case dw_val_class_str
:
5970 if (AT_string (a
) != NULL
)
5971 fprintf (outfile
, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a
));
5973 fprintf (outfile
, "<null>");
5975 case dw_val_class_file
:
5976 fprintf (outfile
, "\"%s\" (%d)", AT_file (a
)->filename
,
5977 AT_file (a
)->emitted_number
);
5983 fprintf (outfile
, "\n");
5986 if (die
->die_child
!= NULL
)
5989 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die
, c
, print_die (c
, outfile
));
5992 if (print_indent
== 0)
5993 fprintf (outfile
, "\n");
5996 /* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
5997 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
6000 print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *outfile
)
6003 dw_line_info_ref line_info
;
6005 fprintf (outfile
, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
6006 for (i
= 1; i
< line_info_table_in_use
; i
++)
6008 line_info
= &line_info_table
[i
];
6009 fprintf (outfile
, "%5d: %4ld %6ld\n", i
,
6010 line_info
->dw_file_num
,
6011 line_info
->dw_line_num
);
6014 fprintf (outfile
, "\n\n");
6017 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
6020 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die
)
6022 print_die (die
, stderr
);
6025 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
6026 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
6032 print_die (comp_unit_die
, stderr
);
6033 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
)
6034 print_dwarf_line_table (stderr
);
6037 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
6038 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
6039 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
6042 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit
, dw_die_ref bincl_die
)
6044 const char *filename
= get_AT_string (bincl_die
, DW_AT_name
);
6045 dw_die_ref new_unit
= gen_compile_unit_die (filename
);
6047 new_unit
->die_sib
= old_unit
;
6051 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
6054 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit
)
6056 dw_die_ref new_unit
= old_unit
->die_sib
;
6058 old_unit
->die_sib
= NULL
;
6062 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
6063 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
6065 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
6068 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc
, struct md5_ctx
*ctx
)
6070 CHECKSUM (loc
->dw_loc_opc
);
6071 CHECKSUM (loc
->dw_loc_oprnd1
);
6072 CHECKSUM (loc
->dw_loc_oprnd2
);
6075 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
6078 attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at
, struct md5_ctx
*ctx
, int *mark
)
6080 dw_loc_descr_ref loc
;
6083 CHECKSUM (at
->dw_attr
);
6085 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
6086 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6087 if (at
->dw_attr
== DW_AT_producer
)
6090 switch (AT_class (at
))
6092 case dw_val_class_const
:
6093 CHECKSUM (at
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_int
);
6095 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const
:
6096 CHECKSUM (at
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_unsigned
);
6098 case dw_val_class_long_long
:
6099 CHECKSUM (at
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_long_long
);
6101 case dw_val_class_vec
:
6102 CHECKSUM (at
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_vec
);
6104 case dw_val_class_flag
:
6105 CHECKSUM (at
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_flag
);
6107 case dw_val_class_str
:
6108 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at
));
6111 case dw_val_class_addr
:
6113 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r
) == SYMBOL_REF
);
6114 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r
, 0));
6117 case dw_val_class_offset
:
6118 CHECKSUM (at
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_offset
);
6121 case dw_val_class_loc
:
6122 for (loc
= AT_loc (at
); loc
; loc
= loc
->dw_loc_next
)
6123 loc_checksum (loc
, ctx
);
6126 case dw_val_class_die_ref
:
6127 die_checksum (AT_ref (at
), ctx
, mark
);
6130 case dw_val_class_fde_ref
:
6131 case dw_val_class_lbl_id
:
6132 case dw_val_class_lineptr
:
6133 case dw_val_class_macptr
:
6136 case dw_val_class_file
:
6137 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at
)->filename
);
6145 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
6148 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die
, struct md5_ctx
*ctx
, int *mark
)
6154 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6157 CHECKSUM (die
->die_mark
);
6160 die
->die_mark
= ++(*mark
);
6162 CHECKSUM (die
->die_tag
);
6164 for (ix
= 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node
, die
->die_attr
, ix
, a
); ix
++)
6165 attr_checksum (a
, ctx
, mark
);
6167 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die
, c
, die_checksum (c
, ctx
, mark
));
6171 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
6173 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
6175 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1
, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2
, int *mark
)
6177 return loc1
->dw_loc_opc
== loc2
->dw_loc_opc
6178 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1
->dw_loc_oprnd1
, &loc2
->dw_loc_oprnd1
, mark
)
6179 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1
->dw_loc_oprnd2
, &loc2
->dw_loc_oprnd2
, mark
);
6182 /* Do the values look the same? */
6184 same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node
*v1
, const dw_val_node
*v2
, int *mark
)
6186 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1
, loc2
;
6189 if (v1
->val_class
!= v2
->val_class
)
6192 switch (v1
->val_class
)
6194 case dw_val_class_const
:
6195 return v1
->v
.val_int
== v2
->v
.val_int
;
6196 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const
:
6197 return v1
->v
.val_unsigned
== v2
->v
.val_unsigned
;
6198 case dw_val_class_long_long
:
6199 return v1
->v
.val_long_long
.hi
== v2
->v
.val_long_long
.hi
6200 && v1
->v
.val_long_long
.low
== v2
->v
.val_long_long
.low
;
6201 case dw_val_class_vec
:
6202 if (v1
->v
.val_vec
.length
!= v2
->v
.val_vec
.length
6203 || v1
->v
.val_vec
.elt_size
!= v2
->v
.val_vec
.elt_size
)
6205 if (memcmp (v1
->v
.val_vec
.array
, v2
->v
.val_vec
.array
,
6206 v1
->v
.val_vec
.length
* v1
->v
.val_vec
.elt_size
))
6209 case dw_val_class_flag
:
6210 return v1
->v
.val_flag
== v2
->v
.val_flag
;
6211 case dw_val_class_str
:
6212 return !strcmp(v1
->v
.val_str
->str
, v2
->v
.val_str
->str
);
6214 case dw_val_class_addr
:
6215 r1
= v1
->v
.val_addr
;
6216 r2
= v2
->v
.val_addr
;
6217 if (GET_CODE (r1
) != GET_CODE (r2
))
6219 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r1
) == SYMBOL_REF
);
6220 return !strcmp (XSTR (r1
, 0), XSTR (r2
, 0));
6222 case dw_val_class_offset
:
6223 return v1
->v
.val_offset
== v2
->v
.val_offset
;
6225 case dw_val_class_loc
:
6226 for (loc1
= v1
->v
.val_loc
, loc2
= v2
->v
.val_loc
;
6228 loc1
= loc1
->dw_loc_next
, loc2
= loc2
->dw_loc_next
)
6229 if (!same_loc_p (loc1
, loc2
, mark
))
6231 return !loc1
&& !loc2
;
6233 case dw_val_class_die_ref
:
6234 return same_die_p (v1
->v
.val_die_ref
.die
, v2
->v
.val_die_ref
.die
, mark
);
6236 case dw_val_class_fde_ref
:
6237 case dw_val_class_lbl_id
:
6238 case dw_val_class_lineptr
:
6239 case dw_val_class_macptr
:
6242 case dw_val_class_file
:
6243 return v1
->v
.val_file
== v2
->v
.val_file
;
6250 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
6253 same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1
, dw_attr_ref at2
, int *mark
)
6255 if (at1
->dw_attr
!= at2
->dw_attr
)
6258 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
6259 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6260 if (at1
->dw_attr
== DW_AT_producer
)
6263 return same_dw_val_p (&at1
->dw_attr_val
, &at2
->dw_attr_val
, mark
);
6266 /* Do the dies look the same? */
6269 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1
, dw_die_ref die2
, int *mark
)
6275 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6277 return die1
->die_mark
== die2
->die_mark
;
6278 die1
->die_mark
= die2
->die_mark
= ++(*mark
);
6280 if (die1
->die_tag
!= die2
->die_tag
)
6283 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node
, die1
->die_attr
)
6284 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node
, die2
->die_attr
))
6287 for (ix
= 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node
, die1
->die_attr
, ix
, a1
); ix
++)
6288 if (!same_attr_p (a1
, VEC_index (dw_attr_node
, die2
->die_attr
, ix
), mark
))
6291 c1
= die1
->die_child
;
6292 c2
= die2
->die_child
;
6301 if (!same_die_p (c1
, c2
, mark
))
6305 if (c1
== die1
->die_child
)
6307 if (c2
== die2
->die_child
)
6317 /* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
6320 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1
, dw_die_ref die2
)
6323 int ret
= same_die_p (die1
, die2
, &mark
);
6325 unmark_all_dies (die1
);
6326 unmark_all_dies (die2
);
6331 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
6333 static char *comdat_symbol_id
;
6335 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
6336 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number
;
6338 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
6339 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
6342 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die
)
6344 const char *die_name
= get_AT_string (unit_die
, DW_AT_name
);
6345 const char *base
= die_name
? lbasename (die_name
) : "anonymous";
6346 char *name
= alloca (strlen (base
) + 64);
6349 unsigned char checksum
[16];
6352 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
6353 the name filename of the unit. */
6355 md5_init_ctx (&ctx
);
6357 die_checksum (unit_die
, &ctx
, &mark
);
6358 unmark_all_dies (unit_die
);
6359 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx
, checksum
);
6361 sprintf (name
, "%s.", base
);
6362 clean_symbol_name (name
);
6364 p
= name
+ strlen (name
);
6365 for (i
= 0; i
< 4; i
++)
6367 sprintf (p
, "%.2x", checksum
[i
]);
6371 comdat_symbol_id
= unit_die
->die_symbol
= xstrdup (name
);
6372 comdat_symbol_number
= 0;
6375 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
6378 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die
)
6380 switch (die
->die_tag
)
6382 case DW_TAG_array_type
:
6383 case DW_TAG_class_type
:
6384 case DW_TAG_interface_type
:
6385 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type
:
6386 case DW_TAG_pointer_type
:
6387 case DW_TAG_reference_type
:
6388 case DW_TAG_string_type
:
6389 case DW_TAG_structure_type
:
6390 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type
:
6391 case DW_TAG_union_type
:
6392 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type
:
6393 case DW_TAG_set_type
:
6394 case DW_TAG_subrange_type
:
6395 case DW_TAG_base_type
:
6396 case DW_TAG_const_type
:
6397 case DW_TAG_file_type
:
6398 case DW_TAG_packed_type
:
6399 case DW_TAG_volatile_type
:
6400 case DW_TAG_typedef
:
6407 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
6408 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
6409 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
6410 compilations (functions). */
6413 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c
)
6415 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
6416 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
6417 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
6418 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
6420 if (c
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_base_type
)
6423 if (c
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_pointer_type
6424 || c
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_reference_type
6425 || c
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_const_type
6426 || c
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_volatile_type
)
6428 dw_die_ref t
= get_AT_ref (c
, DW_AT_type
);
6430 return t
? is_comdat_die (t
) : 0;
6433 return is_type_die (c
);
6436 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
6437 compilation unit. */
6440 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c
)
6442 return (is_type_die (c
)
6443 || (get_AT (c
, DW_AT_declaration
)
6444 && !get_AT (c
, DW_AT_specification
))
6445 || c
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_namespace
);
6449 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix
)
6453 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf
, prefix
, label_num
++);
6454 return xstrdup (buf
);
6457 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
6460 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die
)
6464 if (is_symbol_die (die
))
6466 if (comdat_symbol_id
)
6468 char *p
= alloca (strlen (comdat_symbol_id
) + 64);
6470 sprintf (p
, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX
,
6471 comdat_symbol_id
, comdat_symbol_number
++);
6472 die
->die_symbol
= xstrdup (p
);
6475 die
->die_symbol
= gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
6478 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die
, c
, assign_symbol_names (c
));
6481 struct cu_hash_table_entry
6484 unsigned min_comdat_num
, max_comdat_num
;
6485 struct cu_hash_table_entry
*next
;
6488 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
6490 htab_cu_hash (const void *of
)
6492 const struct cu_hash_table_entry
*entry
= of
;
6494 return htab_hash_string (entry
->cu
->die_symbol
);
6498 htab_cu_eq (const void *of1
, const void *of2
)
6500 const struct cu_hash_table_entry
*entry1
= of1
;
6501 const struct die_struct
*entry2
= of2
;
6503 return !strcmp (entry1
->cu
->die_symbol
, entry2
->die_symbol
);
6507 htab_cu_del (void *what
)
6509 struct cu_hash_table_entry
*next
, *entry
= what
;
6519 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
6522 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu
, htab_t htable
, unsigned int *sym_num
)
6524 struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy
;
6525 struct cu_hash_table_entry
**slot
, *entry
, *last
= &dummy
;
6527 dummy
.max_comdat_num
= 0;
6529 slot
= (struct cu_hash_table_entry
**)
6530 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable
, cu
, htab_hash_string (cu
->die_symbol
),
6534 for (; entry
; last
= entry
, entry
= entry
->next
)
6536 if (same_die_p_wrap (cu
, entry
->cu
))
6542 *sym_num
= entry
->min_comdat_num
;
6546 entry
= XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry
);
6548 entry
->min_comdat_num
= *sym_num
= last
->max_comdat_num
;
6549 entry
->next
= *slot
;
6555 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
6557 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu
, htab_t htable
, unsigned int sym_num
)
6559 struct cu_hash_table_entry
**slot
, *entry
;
6561 slot
= (struct cu_hash_table_entry
**)
6562 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable
, cu
, htab_hash_string (cu
->die_symbol
),
6566 entry
->max_comdat_num
= sym_num
;
6569 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
6570 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
6571 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
6574 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die
)
6577 dw_die_ref unit
= NULL
;
6578 limbo_die_node
*node
, **pnode
;
6579 htab_t cu_hash_table
;
6583 dw_die_ref prev
= c
;
6585 while (c
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
|| c
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
6586 || (unit
&& is_comdat_die (c
)))
6588 dw_die_ref next
= c
->die_sib
;
6590 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
6591 remove_child_with_prev (c
, prev
);
6593 if (c
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
)
6594 unit
= push_new_compile_unit (unit
, c
);
6595 else if (c
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
)
6596 unit
= pop_compile_unit (unit
);
6598 add_child_die (unit
, c
);
6600 if (c
== die
->die_child
)
6603 } while (c
!= die
->die_child
);
6606 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
6607 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
6611 assign_symbol_names (die
);
6612 cu_hash_table
= htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash
, htab_cu_eq
, htab_cu_del
);
6613 for (node
= limbo_die_list
, pnode
= &limbo_die_list
;
6619 compute_section_prefix (node
->die
);
6620 is_dupl
= check_duplicate_cu (node
->die
, cu_hash_table
,
6621 &comdat_symbol_number
);
6622 assign_symbol_names (node
->die
);
6624 *pnode
= node
->next
;
6627 pnode
= &node
->next
;
6628 record_comdat_symbol_number (node
->die
, cu_hash_table
,
6629 comdat_symbol_number
);
6632 htab_delete (cu_hash_table
);
6635 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
6636 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
6637 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
6640 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die
)
6644 if (! die
->die_child
)
6647 if (die
->die_parent
&& die
!= die
->die_parent
->die_child
)
6648 add_AT_die_ref (die
, DW_AT_sibling
, die
->die_sib
);
6650 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die
, c
, add_sibling_attributes (c
));
6653 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
6656 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die
)
6662 for (ix
= 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node
, die
->die_attr
, ix
, a
); ix
++)
6663 if (AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_loc_list
)
6664 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a
));
6666 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die
, c
, output_location_lists (c
));
6669 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
6670 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
6671 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
6672 die are visited recursively. */
6675 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die
)
6677 unsigned long abbrev_id
;
6678 unsigned int n_alloc
;
6683 /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
6684 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
6685 for (ix
= 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node
, die
->die_attr
, ix
, a
); ix
++)
6686 if (AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_die_ref
6687 && AT_ref (a
)->die_mark
== 0)
6689 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a
)->die_symbol
);
6691 set_AT_ref_external (a
, 1);
6694 for (abbrev_id
= 1; abbrev_id
< abbrev_die_table_in_use
; ++abbrev_id
)
6696 dw_die_ref abbrev
= abbrev_die_table
[abbrev_id
];
6697 dw_attr_ref die_a
, abbrev_a
;
6701 if (abbrev
->die_tag
!= die
->die_tag
)
6703 if ((abbrev
->die_child
!= NULL
) != (die
->die_child
!= NULL
))
6706 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node
, abbrev
->die_attr
)
6707 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node
, die
->die_attr
))
6710 for (ix
= 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node
, die
->die_attr
, ix
, die_a
); ix
++)
6712 abbrev_a
= VEC_index (dw_attr_node
, abbrev
->die_attr
, ix
);
6713 if ((abbrev_a
->dw_attr
!= die_a
->dw_attr
)
6714 || (value_format (abbrev_a
) != value_format (die_a
)))
6724 if (abbrev_id
>= abbrev_die_table_in_use
)
6726 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use
>= abbrev_die_table_allocated
)
6728 n_alloc
= abbrev_die_table_allocated
+ ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT
;
6729 abbrev_die_table
= ggc_realloc (abbrev_die_table
,
6730 sizeof (dw_die_ref
) * n_alloc
);
6732 memset (&abbrev_die_table
[abbrev_die_table_allocated
], 0,
6733 (n_alloc
- abbrev_die_table_allocated
) * sizeof (dw_die_ref
));
6734 abbrev_die_table_allocated
= n_alloc
;
6737 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use
;
6738 abbrev_die_table
[abbrev_id
] = die
;
6741 die
->die_abbrev
= abbrev_id
;
6742 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die
, c
, build_abbrev_table (c
));
6745 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
6748 constant_size (long unsigned int value
)
6755 log
= floor_log2 (value
);
6758 log
= 1 << (floor_log2 (log
) + 1);
6763 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
6764 .debug_info section. */
6766 static unsigned long
6767 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die
)
6769 unsigned long size
= 0;
6773 size
+= size_of_uleb128 (die
->die_abbrev
);
6774 for (ix
= 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node
, die
->die_attr
, ix
, a
); ix
++)
6776 switch (AT_class (a
))
6778 case dw_val_class_addr
:
6779 size
+= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
;
6781 case dw_val_class_offset
:
6782 size
+= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
;
6784 case dw_val_class_loc
:
6786 unsigned long lsize
= size_of_locs (AT_loc (a
));
6789 size
+= constant_size (lsize
);
6793 case dw_val_class_loc_list
:
6794 size
+= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
;
6796 case dw_val_class_range_list
:
6797 size
+= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
;
6799 case dw_val_class_const
:
6800 size
+= size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a
));
6802 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const
:
6803 size
+= constant_size (AT_unsigned (a
));
6805 case dw_val_class_long_long
:
6806 size
+= 1 + 2*HOST_BITS_PER_LONG
/HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR
; /* block */
6808 case dw_val_class_vec
:
6809 size
+= 1 + (a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_vec
.length
6810 * a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_vec
.elt_size
); /* block */
6812 case dw_val_class_flag
:
6815 case dw_val_class_die_ref
:
6816 if (AT_ref_external (a
))
6817 size
+= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
;
6819 size
+= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
;
6821 case dw_val_class_fde_ref
:
6822 size
+= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
;
6824 case dw_val_class_lbl_id
:
6825 size
+= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
;
6827 case dw_val_class_lineptr
:
6828 case dw_val_class_macptr
:
6829 size
+= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
;
6831 case dw_val_class_str
:
6832 if (AT_string_form (a
) == DW_FORM_strp
)
6833 size
+= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
;
6835 size
+= strlen (a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_str
->str
) + 1;
6837 case dw_val_class_file
:
6838 size
+= constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_file
));
6848 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
6849 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
6850 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
6851 die_offset field in each DIE. */
6854 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die
)
6858 die
->die_offset
= next_die_offset
;
6859 next_die_offset
+= size_of_die (die
);
6861 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die
, c
, calc_die_sizes (c
));
6863 if (die
->die_child
!= NULL
)
6864 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
6865 next_die_offset
+= 1;
6868 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
6869 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
6870 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
6871 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
6874 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die
)
6878 gcc_assert (!die
->die_mark
);
6881 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die
, c
, mark_dies (c
));
6884 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
6887 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die
)
6891 gcc_assert (die
->die_mark
);
6894 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die
, c
, unmark_dies (c
));
6897 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
6900 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die
)
6910 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die
, c
, unmark_all_dies (c
));
6912 for (ix
= 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node
, die
->die_attr
, ix
, a
); ix
++)
6913 if (AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_die_ref
)
6914 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a
));
6917 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
6918 generated for the compilation unit. */
6920 static unsigned long
6921 size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry
, gc
) * names
)
6927 size
= DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE
;
6928 for (i
= 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry
, names
, i
, p
); i
++)
6929 if (names
!= pubtype_table
6930 || p
->die
->die_offset
!= 0
6931 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types
)
6932 size
+= strlen (p
->name
) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
+ 1;
6934 size
+= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
;
6938 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
6940 static unsigned long
6941 size_of_aranges (void)
6945 size
= DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE
;
6947 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
6948 if (text_section_used
)
6949 size
+= 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
;
6950 if (cold_text_section_used
)
6951 size
+= 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
;
6952 size
+= 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
* arange_table_in_use
;
6954 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
6955 size
+= 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
;
6959 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
6961 static enum dwarf_form
6962 value_format (dw_attr_ref a
)
6964 switch (a
->dw_attr_val
.val_class
)
6966 case dw_val_class_addr
:
6967 return DW_FORM_addr
;
6968 case dw_val_class_range_list
:
6969 case dw_val_class_offset
:
6970 case dw_val_class_loc_list
:
6971 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
)
6974 return DW_FORM_data4
;
6976 return DW_FORM_data8
;
6980 case dw_val_class_loc
:
6981 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a
))))
6984 return DW_FORM_block1
;
6986 return DW_FORM_block2
;
6990 case dw_val_class_const
:
6991 return DW_FORM_sdata
;
6992 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const
:
6993 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a
)))
6996 return DW_FORM_data1
;
6998 return DW_FORM_data2
;
7000 return DW_FORM_data4
;
7002 return DW_FORM_data8
;
7006 case dw_val_class_long_long
:
7007 return DW_FORM_block1
;
7008 case dw_val_class_vec
:
7009 return DW_FORM_block1
;
7010 case dw_val_class_flag
:
7011 return DW_FORM_flag
;
7012 case dw_val_class_die_ref
:
7013 if (AT_ref_external (a
))
7014 return DW_FORM_ref_addr
;
7017 case dw_val_class_fde_ref
:
7018 return DW_FORM_data
;
7019 case dw_val_class_lbl_id
:
7020 return DW_FORM_addr
;
7021 case dw_val_class_lineptr
:
7022 case dw_val_class_macptr
:
7023 return DW_FORM_data
;
7024 case dw_val_class_str
:
7025 return AT_string_form (a
);
7026 case dw_val_class_file
:
7027 switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_file
)))
7030 return DW_FORM_data1
;
7032 return DW_FORM_data2
;
7034 return DW_FORM_data4
;
7044 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
7047 output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a
)
7049 enum dwarf_form form
= value_format (a
);
7051 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form
, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form
));
7054 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
7058 output_abbrev_section (void)
7060 unsigned long abbrev_id
;
7062 for (abbrev_id
= 1; abbrev_id
< abbrev_die_table_in_use
; ++abbrev_id
)
7064 dw_die_ref abbrev
= abbrev_die_table
[abbrev_id
];
7068 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id
, "(abbrev code)");
7069 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev
->die_tag
, "(TAG: %s)",
7070 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev
->die_tag
));
7072 if (abbrev
->die_child
!= NULL
)
7073 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes
, "DW_children_yes");
7075 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no
, "DW_children_no");
7077 for (ix
= 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node
, abbrev
->die_attr
, ix
, a_attr
);
7080 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr
->dw_attr
, "(%s)",
7081 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr
->dw_attr
));
7082 output_value_format (a_attr
);
7085 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL
);
7086 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL
);
7089 /* Terminate the table. */
7090 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL
);
7093 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
7096 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die
)
7098 char *sym
= die
->die_symbol
;
7103 if (strncmp (sym
, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX
, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX
) - 1) == 0)
7104 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
7105 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
7107 targetm
.asm_out
.globalize_label (asm_out_file
, sym
);
7109 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, sym
);
7112 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
7113 expression. gensym tells us whether to generate a new internal symbol for
7114 this location list node, which is done for the head of the list only. */
7116 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
7117 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr
, const char *begin
, const char *end
,
7118 const char *section
, unsigned int gensym
)
7120 dw_loc_list_ref retlist
= ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_list_node
));
7122 retlist
->begin
= begin
;
7124 retlist
->expr
= expr
;
7125 retlist
->section
= section
;
7127 retlist
->ll_symbol
= gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
7132 /* Add a location description expression to a location list. */
7135 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref
*list_head
, dw_loc_descr_ref descr
,
7136 const char *begin
, const char *end
,
7137 const char *section
)
7141 /* Find the end of the chain. */
7142 for (d
= list_head
; (*d
) != NULL
; d
= &(*d
)->dw_loc_next
)
7145 /* Add a new location list node to the list. */
7146 *d
= new_loc_list (descr
, begin
, end
, section
, 0);
7149 /* Output the location list given to us. */
7152 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head
)
7154 dw_loc_list_ref curr
= list_head
;
7156 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, list_head
->ll_symbol
);
7158 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
7159 for (curr
= list_head
; curr
!= NULL
; curr
= curr
->dw_loc_next
)
7162 /* Don't output an entry that starts and ends at the same address. */
7163 if (strcmp (curr
->begin
, curr
->end
) == 0)
7165 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
)
7167 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, curr
->begin
, curr
->section
,
7168 "Location list begin address (%s)",
7169 list_head
->ll_symbol
);
7170 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, curr
->end
, curr
->section
,
7171 "Location list end address (%s)",
7172 list_head
->ll_symbol
);
7176 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, curr
->begin
,
7177 "Location list begin address (%s)",
7178 list_head
->ll_symbol
);
7179 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, curr
->end
,
7180 "Location list end address (%s)",
7181 list_head
->ll_symbol
);
7183 size
= size_of_locs (curr
->expr
);
7185 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
7186 gcc_assert (size
<= 0xffff);
7187 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size
, "%s", "Location expression size");
7189 output_loc_sequence (curr
->expr
);
7192 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, 0,
7193 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
7194 list_head
->ll_symbol
);
7195 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, 0,
7196 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
7197 list_head
->ll_symbol
);
7200 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
7201 the definitions of each child DIE. */
7204 output_die (dw_die_ref die
)
7211 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
7212 them to point to. */
7213 if (die
->die_symbol
)
7214 output_die_symbol (die
);
7216 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die
->die_abbrev
, "(DIE (0x%lx) %s)",
7217 (unsigned long)die
->die_offset
,
7218 dwarf_tag_name (die
->die_tag
));
7220 for (ix
= 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node
, die
->die_attr
, ix
, a
); ix
++)
7222 const char *name
= dwarf_attr_name (a
->dw_attr
);
7224 switch (AT_class (a
))
7226 case dw_val_class_addr
:
7227 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, AT_addr (a
), "%s", name
);
7230 case dw_val_class_offset
:
7231 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_offset
,
7235 case dw_val_class_range_list
:
7237 char *p
= strchr (ranges_section_label
, '\0');
7239 sprintf (p
, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX
,
7240 a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_offset
);
7241 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, ranges_section_label
,
7242 debug_ranges_section
, "%s", name
);
7247 case dw_val_class_loc
:
7248 size
= size_of_locs (AT_loc (a
));
7250 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
7251 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size
), size
, "%s", name
);
7253 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a
));
7256 case dw_val_class_const
:
7257 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
7258 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
7259 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
7260 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a
), "%s", name
);
7263 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const
:
7264 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a
)),
7265 AT_unsigned (a
), "%s", name
);
7268 case dw_val_class_long_long
:
7270 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first
, second
;
7272 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
7273 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_LONG
/ HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR
,
7276 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
)
7278 first
= a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_long_long
.hi
;
7279 second
= a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_long_long
.low
;
7283 first
= a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_long_long
.low
;
7284 second
= a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_long_long
.hi
;
7287 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG
/ HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR
,
7288 first
, "long long constant");
7289 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG
/ HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR
,
7294 case dw_val_class_vec
:
7296 unsigned int elt_size
= a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_vec
.elt_size
;
7297 unsigned int len
= a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_vec
.length
;
7301 dw2_asm_output_data (1, len
* elt_size
, "%s", name
);
7302 if (elt_size
> sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT
))
7307 for (i
= 0, p
= a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_vec
.array
;
7310 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size
, extract_int (p
, elt_size
),
7311 "fp or vector constant word %u", i
);
7315 case dw_val_class_flag
:
7316 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a
), "%s", name
);
7319 case dw_val_class_loc_list
:
7321 char *sym
= AT_loc_list (a
)->ll_symbol
;
7324 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, sym
, debug_loc_section
,
7329 case dw_val_class_die_ref
:
7330 if (AT_ref_external (a
))
7332 char *sym
= AT_ref (a
)->die_symbol
;
7335 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, sym
, debug_info_section
,
7340 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a
)->die_offset
);
7341 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, AT_ref (a
)->die_offset
,
7346 case dw_val_class_fde_ref
:
7350 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1
, FDE_LABEL
,
7351 a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_fde_index
* 2);
7352 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, l1
, debug_frame_section
,
7357 case dw_val_class_lbl_id
:
7358 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, AT_lbl (a
), "%s", name
);
7361 case dw_val_class_lineptr
:
7362 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, AT_lbl (a
),
7363 debug_line_section
, "%s", name
);
7366 case dw_val_class_macptr
:
7367 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, AT_lbl (a
),
7368 debug_macinfo_section
, "%s", name
);
7371 case dw_val_class_str
:
7372 if (AT_string_form (a
) == DW_FORM_strp
)
7373 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
,
7374 a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_str
->label
,
7376 "%s: \"%s\"", name
, AT_string (a
));
7378 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a
), -1, "%s", name
);
7381 case dw_val_class_file
:
7383 int f
= maybe_emit_file (a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_file
);
7385 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f
), f
, "%s (%s)", name
,
7386 a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_file
->filename
);
7395 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die
, c
, output_die (c
));
7397 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
7398 if (die
->die_child
!= NULL
)
7399 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE 0x%lx",
7400 (unsigned long) die
->die_offset
);
7403 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
7404 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
7407 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
7409 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
- DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
== 4)
7410 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7411 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7412 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
,
7413 next_die_offset
- DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
,
7414 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
7415 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION
, "DWARF version number");
7416 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, abbrev_section_label
,
7417 debug_abbrev_section
,
7418 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
7419 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
7422 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
7425 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die
, int output_if_empty
)
7427 const char *secname
;
7430 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
7431 if (!output_if_empty
&& die
->die_child
== NULL
)
7434 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
7435 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
7436 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
7437 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
7438 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
7441 build_abbrev_table (die
);
7443 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
7444 next_die_offset
= DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE
;
7445 calc_die_sizes (die
);
7447 oldsym
= die
->die_symbol
;
7450 tmp
= alloca (strlen (oldsym
) + 24);
7452 sprintf (tmp
, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym
);
7454 die
->die_symbol
= NULL
;
7455 switch_to_section (get_section (secname
, SECTION_DEBUG
, NULL
));
7458 switch_to_section (debug_info_section
);
7460 /* Output debugging information. */
7461 output_compilation_unit_header ();
7464 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
7469 die
->die_symbol
= oldsym
;
7473 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl. */
7476 dwarf2_name (tree decl
, int scope
)
7478 return lang_hooks
.dwarf_name (decl
, scope
? 1 : 0);
7481 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
7484 add_pubname (tree decl
, dw_die_ref die
)
7488 if (! TREE_PUBLIC (decl
))
7492 e
.name
= xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl
, 1));
7493 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry
, gc
, pubname_table
, &e
);
7496 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate. */
7499 add_pubtype (tree decl
, dw_die_ref die
)
7504 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl
)
7505 || die
->die_parent
== comp_unit_die
)
7506 && (die
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_typedef
|| COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl
)))
7511 if (TYPE_NAME (decl
))
7513 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl
)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE
)
7514 e
.name
= IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TYPE_NAME (decl
));
7515 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl
)) == TYPE_DECL
7516 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl
)))
7517 e
.name
= IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl
)));
7519 e
.name
= xstrdup ((const char *) get_AT_string (die
, DW_AT_name
));
7523 e
.name
= xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl
, 1));
7525 /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
7527 if (e
.name
&& e
.name
[0] != '\0')
7528 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry
, gc
, pubtype_table
, &e
);
7532 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
7533 visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions. */
7536 output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry
, gc
) * names
)
7539 unsigned long pubnames_length
= size_of_pubnames (names
);
7542 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
- DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
== 4)
7543 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7544 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7545 if (names
== pubname_table
)
7546 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, pubnames_length
,
7547 "Length of Public Names Info");
7549 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, pubnames_length
,
7550 "Length of Public Type Names Info");
7551 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION
, "DWARF Version");
7552 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, debug_info_section_label
,
7554 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7555 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, next_die_offset
,
7556 "Compilation Unit Length");
7558 for (i
= 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry
, names
, i
, pub
); i
++)
7560 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
7561 if (names
== pubname_table
)
7562 gcc_assert (pub
->die
->die_mark
);
7564 if (names
!= pubtype_table
7565 || pub
->die
->die_offset
!= 0
7566 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types
)
7568 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, pub
->die
->die_offset
,
7571 dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub
->name
, -1, "external name");
7575 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, 0, NULL
);
7578 /* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate. */
7581 add_arange (tree decl
, dw_die_ref die
)
7583 if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl
))
7586 if (arange_table_in_use
== arange_table_allocated
)
7588 arange_table_allocated
+= ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT
;
7589 arange_table
= ggc_realloc (arange_table
,
7590 (arange_table_allocated
7591 * sizeof (dw_die_ref
)));
7592 memset (arange_table
+ arange_table_in_use
, 0,
7593 ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT
* sizeof (dw_die_ref
));
7596 arange_table
[arange_table_in_use
++] = die
;
7599 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
7600 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
7601 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
7604 output_aranges (void)
7607 unsigned long aranges_length
= size_of_aranges ();
7609 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
- DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
== 4)
7610 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7611 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7612 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, aranges_length
,
7613 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
7614 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION
, "DWARF Version");
7615 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, debug_info_section_label
,
7617 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7618 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, "Size of Address");
7619 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
7621 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
7622 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE
)
7624 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
7626 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
7627 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
);
7628 for (i
= 2; i
< (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE
; i
+= 2)
7629 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL
);
7632 /* It is necessary not to output these entries if the sections were
7633 not used; if the sections were not used, the length will be 0 and
7634 the address may end up as 0 if the section is discarded by ld
7635 --gc-sections, leaving an invalid (0, 0) entry that can be
7636 confused with the terminator. */
7637 if (text_section_used
)
7639 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, text_section_label
, "Address");
7640 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, text_end_label
,
7641 text_section_label
, "Length");
7643 if (cold_text_section_used
)
7645 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, cold_text_section_label
,
7647 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, cold_end_label
,
7648 cold_text_section_label
, "Length");
7651 for (i
= 0; i
< arange_table_in_use
; i
++)
7653 dw_die_ref die
= arange_table
[i
];
7655 /* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
7656 gcc_assert (die
->die_mark
);
7658 if (die
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_subprogram
)
7660 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, get_AT_low_pc (die
),
7662 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, get_AT_hi_pc (die
),
7663 get_AT_low_pc (die
), "Length");
7667 /* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
7668 Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
7669 aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99). */
7670 dw_attr_ref a
= get_AT (die
, DW_AT_location
);
7671 dw_loc_descr_ref loc
;
7673 gcc_assert (a
&& AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_loc
);
7676 gcc_assert (loc
->dw_loc_opc
== DW_OP_addr
);
7678 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
,
7679 loc
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_addr
, "Address");
7680 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
,
7681 get_AT_unsigned (die
, DW_AT_byte_size
),
7686 /* Output the terminator words. */
7687 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, 0, NULL
);
7688 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, 0, NULL
);
7691 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
7695 add_ranges_num (int num
)
7697 unsigned int in_use
= ranges_table_in_use
;
7699 if (in_use
== ranges_table_allocated
)
7701 ranges_table_allocated
+= RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT
;
7703 = ggc_realloc (ranges_table
, (ranges_table_allocated
7704 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct
)));
7705 memset (ranges_table
+ ranges_table_in_use
, 0,
7706 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT
* sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct
));
7709 ranges_table
[in_use
].num
= num
;
7710 ranges_table_in_use
= in_use
+ 1;
7712 return in_use
* 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
;
7715 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a block, or a
7716 range terminator if BLOCK is NULL. */
7719 add_ranges (const_tree block
)
7721 return add_ranges_num (block
? BLOCK_NUMBER (block
) : 0);
7724 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a pair of
7728 add_ranges_by_labels (const char *begin
, const char *end
)
7730 unsigned int in_use
= ranges_by_label_in_use
;
7732 if (in_use
== ranges_by_label_allocated
)
7734 ranges_by_label_allocated
+= RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT
;
7736 = ggc_realloc (ranges_by_label
,
7737 (ranges_by_label_allocated
7738 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct
)));
7739 memset (ranges_by_label
+ ranges_by_label_in_use
, 0,
7740 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT
7741 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct
));
7744 ranges_by_label
[in_use
].begin
= begin
;
7745 ranges_by_label
[in_use
].end
= end
;
7746 ranges_by_label_in_use
= in_use
+ 1;
7748 return add_ranges_num (-(int)in_use
- 1);
7752 output_ranges (void)
7755 static const char *const start_fmt
= "Offset 0x%x";
7756 const char *fmt
= start_fmt
;
7758 for (i
= 0; i
< ranges_table_in_use
; i
++)
7760 int block_num
= ranges_table
[i
].num
;
7764 char blabel
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
7765 char elabel
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
7767 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel
, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
, block_num
);
7768 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel
, BLOCK_END_LABEL
, block_num
);
7770 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
7771 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
7772 base of the text section. */
7773 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
)
7775 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, blabel
,
7777 fmt
, i
* 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
);
7778 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, elabel
,
7779 text_section_label
, NULL
);
7782 /* Otherwise, the compilation unit base address is zero,
7783 which allows us to use absolute addresses, and not worry
7784 about whether the target supports cross-section
7788 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, blabel
,
7789 fmt
, i
* 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
);
7790 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, elabel
, NULL
);
7796 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
7797 else if (block_num
< 0)
7799 int lab_idx
= - block_num
- 1;
7801 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
)
7805 /* If we ever use add_ranges_by_labels () for a single
7806 function section, all we have to do is to take out
7808 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
,
7809 ranges_by_label
[lab_idx
].begin
,
7811 fmt
, i
* 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
);
7812 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
,
7813 ranges_by_label
[lab_idx
].end
,
7814 text_section_label
, NULL
);
7819 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
,
7820 ranges_by_label
[lab_idx
].begin
,
7821 fmt
, i
* 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
);
7822 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
,
7823 ranges_by_label
[lab_idx
].end
,
7829 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, 0, NULL
);
7830 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, 0, NULL
);
7836 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
7839 const char *path
; /* Complete file name. */
7840 const char *fname
; /* File name part. */
7841 int length
; /* Length of entire string. */
7842 struct dwarf_file_data
* file_idx
; /* Index in input file table. */
7843 int dir_idx
; /* Index in directory table. */
7846 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
7850 const char *path
; /* Path including directory name. */
7851 int length
; /* Path length. */
7852 int prefix
; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
7853 int count
; /* Number of files in this directory. */
7854 int dir_idx
; /* Index of directory used as base. */
7857 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
7858 the directories in the path. */
7861 file_info_cmp (const void *p1
, const void *p2
)
7863 const struct file_info
*s1
= p1
;
7864 const struct file_info
*s2
= p2
;
7865 const unsigned char *cp1
;
7866 const unsigned char *cp2
;
7868 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
7869 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
7870 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
7871 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
7872 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
7873 if ((s1
->path
== s1
->fname
|| s2
->path
== s2
->fname
))
7874 return (s2
->path
== s2
->fname
) - (s1
->path
== s1
->fname
);
7876 cp1
= (const unsigned char *) s1
->path
;
7877 cp2
= (const unsigned char *) s2
->path
;
7883 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
7884 if ((cp1
== (const unsigned char *) s1
->fname
)
7885 || (cp2
== (const unsigned char *) s2
->fname
))
7886 return ((cp2
== (const unsigned char *) s2
->fname
)
7887 - (cp1
== (const unsigned char *) s1
->fname
));
7889 /* Character of current path component the same? */
7890 else if (*cp1
!= *cp2
)
7895 struct file_name_acquire_data
7897 struct file_info
*files
;
7902 /* Traversal function for the hash table. */
7905 file_name_acquire (void ** slot
, void *data
)
7907 struct file_name_acquire_data
*fnad
= data
;
7908 struct dwarf_file_data
*d
= *slot
;
7909 struct file_info
*fi
;
7912 gcc_assert (fnad
->max_files
>= d
->emitted_number
);
7914 if (! d
->emitted_number
)
7917 gcc_assert (fnad
->max_files
!= fnad
->used_files
);
7919 fi
= fnad
->files
+ fnad
->used_files
++;
7921 /* Skip all leading "./". */
7923 while (f
[0] == '.' && IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (f
[1]))
7926 /* Create a new array entry. */
7928 fi
->length
= strlen (f
);
7931 /* Search for the file name part. */
7932 f
= strrchr (f
, DIR_SEPARATOR
);
7933 #if defined (DIR_SEPARATOR_2)
7935 char *g
= strrchr (fi
->path
, DIR_SEPARATOR_2
);
7939 if (f
== NULL
|| f
< g
)
7945 fi
->fname
= f
== NULL
? fi
->path
: f
+ 1;
7949 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
7950 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
7951 slowdowns with many input files. */
7954 output_file_names (void)
7956 struct file_name_acquire_data fnad
;
7958 struct file_info
*files
;
7959 struct dir_info
*dirs
;
7968 if (!last_emitted_file
)
7970 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7971 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7975 numfiles
= last_emitted_file
->emitted_number
;
7977 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
7978 files
= alloca (numfiles
* sizeof (struct file_info
));
7979 dirs
= alloca (numfiles
* sizeof (struct dir_info
));
7982 fnad
.used_files
= 0;
7983 fnad
.max_files
= numfiles
;
7984 htab_traverse (file_table
, file_name_acquire
, &fnad
);
7985 gcc_assert (fnad
.used_files
== fnad
.max_files
);
7987 qsort (files
, numfiles
, sizeof (files
[0]), file_info_cmp
);
7989 /* Find all the different directories used. */
7990 dirs
[0].path
= files
[0].path
;
7991 dirs
[0].length
= files
[0].fname
- files
[0].path
;
7992 dirs
[0].prefix
= -1;
7994 dirs
[0].dir_idx
= 0;
7995 files
[0].dir_idx
= 0;
7998 for (i
= 1; i
< numfiles
; i
++)
7999 if (files
[i
].fname
- files
[i
].path
== dirs
[ndirs
- 1].length
8000 && memcmp (dirs
[ndirs
- 1].path
, files
[i
].path
,
8001 dirs
[ndirs
- 1].length
) == 0)
8003 /* Same directory as last entry. */
8004 files
[i
].dir_idx
= ndirs
- 1;
8005 ++dirs
[ndirs
- 1].count
;
8011 /* This is a new directory. */
8012 dirs
[ndirs
].path
= files
[i
].path
;
8013 dirs
[ndirs
].length
= files
[i
].fname
- files
[i
].path
;
8014 dirs
[ndirs
].count
= 1;
8015 dirs
[ndirs
].dir_idx
= ndirs
;
8016 files
[i
].dir_idx
= ndirs
;
8018 /* Search for a prefix. */
8019 dirs
[ndirs
].prefix
= -1;
8020 for (j
= 0; j
< ndirs
; j
++)
8021 if (dirs
[j
].length
< dirs
[ndirs
].length
8022 && dirs
[j
].length
> 1
8023 && (dirs
[ndirs
].prefix
== -1
8024 || dirs
[j
].length
> dirs
[dirs
[ndirs
].prefix
].length
)
8025 && memcmp (dirs
[j
].path
, dirs
[ndirs
].path
, dirs
[j
].length
) == 0)
8026 dirs
[ndirs
].prefix
= j
;
8031 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
8032 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
8033 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
8034 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
8035 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
8036 results in most cases and never is much off. */
8037 saved
= alloca (ndirs
* sizeof (int));
8038 savehere
= alloca (ndirs
* sizeof (int));
8040 memset (saved
, '\0', ndirs
* sizeof (saved
[0]));
8041 for (i
= 0; i
< ndirs
; i
++)
8046 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
8047 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
8048 savehere
[i
] = dirs
[i
].length
;
8049 total
= (savehere
[i
] - saved
[i
]) * dirs
[i
].count
;
8051 for (j
= i
+ 1; j
< ndirs
; j
++)
8054 if (saved
[j
] < dirs
[i
].length
)
8056 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
8061 while (k
!= -1 && k
!= (int) i
)
8066 /* Yes it is. We can possibly save some memory by
8067 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
8069 savehere
[j
] = dirs
[i
].length
;
8070 total
+= (savehere
[j
] - saved
[j
]) * dirs
[j
].count
;
8075 /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
8077 if (total
> dirs
[i
].length
+ 1)
8079 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
8080 for (j
= i
; j
< ndirs
; j
++)
8081 if (savehere
[j
] > 0)
8083 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
8084 saved
[j
] = savehere
[j
];
8086 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
8087 dirs
[j
].dir_idx
= i
;
8092 /* Emit the directory name table. */
8094 idx_offset
= dirs
[0].length
> 0 ? 1 : 0;
8095 for (i
= 1 - idx_offset
; i
< ndirs
; i
++)
8096 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs
[i
].path
, dirs
[i
].length
- 1,
8097 "Directory Entry: 0x%x", i
+ idx_offset
);
8099 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
8101 /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
8102 used in the debug info generation. To do this efficiently we
8103 generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
8104 backmap
= alloca (numfiles
* sizeof (int));
8105 for (i
= 0; i
< numfiles
; i
++)
8106 backmap
[files
[i
].file_idx
->emitted_number
- 1] = i
;
8108 /* Now write all the file names. */
8109 for (i
= 0; i
< numfiles
; i
++)
8111 int file_idx
= backmap
[i
];
8112 int dir_idx
= dirs
[files
[file_idx
].dir_idx
].dir_idx
;
8114 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files
[file_idx
].path
+ dirs
[dir_idx
].length
, -1,
8115 "File Entry: 0x%x", (unsigned) i
+ 1);
8117 /* Include directory index. */
8118 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx
+ idx_offset
, NULL
);
8120 /* Modification time. */
8121 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL
);
8123 /* File length in bytes. */
8124 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL
);
8127 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
8131 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
8132 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
8135 output_line_info (void)
8137 char l1
[20], l2
[20], p1
[20], p2
[20];
8138 char line_label
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
8139 char prev_line_label
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
8142 unsigned long lt_index
;
8143 unsigned long current_line
;
8146 unsigned long current_file
;
8147 unsigned long function
;
8149 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1
, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL
, 0);
8150 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2
, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL
, 0);
8151 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1
, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL
, 0);
8152 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2
, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL
, 0);
8154 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
- DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
== 4)
8155 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
8156 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
8157 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, l2
, l1
,
8158 "Length of Source Line Info");
8159 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, l1
);
8161 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION
, "DWARF Version");
8162 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
, p2
, p1
, "Prolog Length");
8163 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, p1
);
8165 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
8166 bytes). In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
8167 information purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language,
8168 we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
8169 generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
8170 DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
8171 commands. Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
8172 enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override. */
8173 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
8174 "Minimum Instruction Length");
8176 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START
,
8177 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
8178 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE
,
8179 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
8180 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE
,
8181 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
8182 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE
,
8183 "Special Opcode Base");
8185 for (opc
= 1; opc
< DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE
; opc
++)
8189 case DW_LNS_advance_pc
:
8190 case DW_LNS_advance_line
:
8191 case DW_LNS_set_file
:
8192 case DW_LNS_set_column
:
8193 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc
:
8201 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args
, "opcode: 0x%x has %d args",
8205 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
8206 output_file_names ();
8207 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, p2
);
8209 /* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
8210 section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
8211 have a line note for the opening brace of the first function. */
8213 /* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
8214 a series of state machine operations. */
8218 if (cfun
&& in_cold_section_p
)
8219 strcpy (prev_line_label
, cfun
->cold_section_label
);
8221 strcpy (prev_line_label
, text_section_label
);
8222 for (lt_index
= 1; lt_index
< line_info_table_in_use
; ++lt_index
)
8224 dw_line_info_ref line_info
= &line_info_table
[lt_index
];
8227 /* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
8228 at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
8231 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. Just updating the
8232 address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
8233 that anything after the last address is this line. */
8234 if (line_info
->dw_line_num
== current_line
8235 && line_info
->dw_file_num
== current_file
)
8239 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
8241 Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
8242 use the most general form. GCC does not know the address delta
8243 itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many ports do have length
8244 attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range. We
8245 could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
8246 use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
8248 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label
, LINE_CODE_LABEL
, lt_index
);
8251 /* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff. This takes 3 bytes. */
8252 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc
,
8253 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8254 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label
, prev_line_label
, NULL
);
8258 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
8259 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
8260 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8261 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, NULL
);
8262 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address
, NULL
);
8263 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, line_label
, NULL
);
8266 strcpy (prev_line_label
, line_label
);
8268 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
8269 different from the previous line. */
8270 if (line_info
->dw_file_num
!= current_file
)
8272 current_file
= line_info
->dw_file_num
;
8273 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file
, "DW_LNS_set_file");
8274 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file
, "%lu", current_file
);
8277 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
8278 that uses the least amount of space. */
8279 if (line_info
->dw_line_num
!= current_line
)
8281 line_offset
= line_info
->dw_line_num
- current_line
;
8282 line_delta
= line_offset
- DWARF_LINE_BASE
;
8283 current_line
= line_info
->dw_line_num
;
8284 if (line_delta
>= 0 && line_delta
< (DWARF_LINE_RANGE
- 1))
8285 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
8286 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE. This
8288 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE
+ line_delta
,
8289 "line %lu", current_line
);
8292 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
8293 depending on the value being encoded. */
8294 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line
,
8295 "advance to line %lu", current_line
);
8296 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset
, NULL
);
8297 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy
, "DW_LNS_copy");
8301 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
8302 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy
, "DW_LNS_copy");
8305 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
8308 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc
,
8309 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8310 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label
, prev_line_label
, NULL
);
8314 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8315 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, NULL
);
8316 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address
, NULL
);
8317 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, text_end_label
, NULL
);
8320 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
8321 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL
);
8322 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence
, NULL
);
8327 for (lt_index
= 0; lt_index
< separate_line_info_table_in_use
;)
8329 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
8330 = &separate_line_info_table
[lt_index
];
8333 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. */
8334 if (line_info
->dw_line_num
== current_line
8335 && line_info
->dw_file_num
== current_file
8336 && line_info
->function
== function
)
8340 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line. If this is
8341 a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
8342 to handle it differently. */
8343 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label
, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
,
8345 if (function
!= line_info
->function
)
8347 function
= line_info
->function
;
8349 /* Set the address register to the first line in the function. */
8350 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8351 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, NULL
);
8352 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address
, NULL
);
8353 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, line_label
, NULL
);
8357 /* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above. */
8360 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc
,
8361 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8362 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label
, prev_line_label
, NULL
);
8366 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8367 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, NULL
);
8368 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address
, NULL
);
8369 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, line_label
, NULL
);
8373 strcpy (prev_line_label
, line_label
);
8375 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
8376 different from the previous line. */
8377 if (line_info
->dw_file_num
!= current_file
)
8379 current_file
= line_info
->dw_file_num
;
8380 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file
, "DW_LNS_set_file");
8381 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file
, "%lu", current_file
);
8384 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
8385 that uses the least amount of space. */
8386 if (line_info
->dw_line_num
!= current_line
)
8388 line_offset
= line_info
->dw_line_num
- current_line
;
8389 line_delta
= line_offset
- DWARF_LINE_BASE
;
8390 current_line
= line_info
->dw_line_num
;
8391 if (line_delta
>= 0 && line_delta
< (DWARF_LINE_RANGE
- 1))
8392 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE
+ line_delta
,
8393 "line %lu", current_line
);
8396 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line
,
8397 "advance to line %lu", current_line
);
8398 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset
, NULL
);
8399 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy
, "DW_LNS_copy");
8403 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy
, "DW_LNS_copy");
8411 /* If we're done with a function, end its sequence. */
8412 if (lt_index
== separate_line_info_table_in_use
8413 || separate_line_info_table
[lt_index
].function
!= function
)
8418 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
8419 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label
, FUNC_END_LABEL
, function
);
8422 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc
,
8423 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8424 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label
, prev_line_label
, NULL
);
8428 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8429 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, NULL
);
8430 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address
, NULL
);
8431 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
, line_label
, NULL
);
8434 /* Output the marker for the end of this sequence. */
8435 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
8436 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL
);
8437 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence
, NULL
);
8441 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
8442 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, l2
);
8445 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
8446 a DIE that describes the given type.
8448 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
8449 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
8452 base_type_die (tree type
)
8454 dw_die_ref base_type_result
;
8455 enum dwarf_type encoding
;
8457 if (TREE_CODE (type
) == ERROR_MARK
|| TREE_CODE (type
) == VOID_TYPE
)
8460 switch (TREE_CODE (type
))
8463 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type
))
8465 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type
))
8466 encoding
= DW_ATE_unsigned_char
;
8468 encoding
= DW_ATE_signed_char
;
8470 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type
))
8471 encoding
= DW_ATE_unsigned
;
8473 encoding
= DW_ATE_signed
;
8477 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type
)))
8478 encoding
= DW_ATE_decimal_float
;
8480 encoding
= DW_ATE_float
;
8483 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE
:
8484 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type
))
8485 encoding
= DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed
;
8487 encoding
= DW_ATE_signed_fixed
;
8490 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
8491 a user defined type for it. */
8493 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type
)) == REAL_TYPE
)
8494 encoding
= DW_ATE_complex_float
;
8496 encoding
= DW_ATE_lo_user
;
8500 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
8501 encoding
= DW_ATE_boolean
;
8505 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
8509 base_type_result
= new_die (DW_TAG_base_type
, comp_unit_die
, type
);
8511 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
8512 if (! TYPE_NAME (type
))
8513 add_name_attribute (base_type_result
, "__unknown__");
8515 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result
, DW_AT_byte_size
,
8516 int_size_in_bytes (type
));
8517 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result
, DW_AT_encoding
, encoding
);
8519 return base_type_result
;
8522 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
8523 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
8526 is_base_type (tree type
)
8528 switch (TREE_CODE (type
))
8534 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE
:
8542 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE
:
8547 case REFERENCE_TYPE
:
8560 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
8561 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
8562 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
8563 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
8566 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
8567 simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type
)
8569 if (TREE_CODE (type
) == ERROR_MARK
)
8570 return BITS_PER_WORD
;
8571 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type
) == NULL_TREE
)
8573 else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type
), 1))
8574 return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type
), 1);
8576 return TYPE_ALIGN (type
);
8579 /* Return true if the debug information for the given type should be
8580 emitted as a subrange type. */
8583 is_subrange_type (const_tree type
)
8585 tree subtype
= TREE_TYPE (type
);
8587 /* Subrange types are identified by the fact that they are integer
8588 types, and that they have a subtype which is either an integer type
8589 or an enumeral type. */
8591 if (TREE_CODE (type
) != INTEGER_TYPE
8592 || subtype
== NULL_TREE
)
8595 if (TREE_CODE (subtype
) != INTEGER_TYPE
8596 && TREE_CODE (subtype
) != ENUMERAL_TYPE
)
8599 if (TREE_CODE (type
) == TREE_CODE (subtype
)
8600 && int_size_in_bytes (type
) == int_size_in_bytes (subtype
)
8601 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type
) != NULL
8602 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype
) != NULL
8603 && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type
), TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype
))
8604 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type
) != NULL
8605 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype
) != NULL
8606 && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type
), TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype
)))
8608 /* The type and its subtype have the same representation. If in
8609 addition the two types also have the same name, then the given
8610 type is not a subrange type, but rather a plain base type. */
8611 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-03-22:
8612 Sizetype INTEGER_CSTs nodes are canonicalized. It should
8613 therefore be sufficient to check the TYPE_SIZE node pointers
8614 rather than checking the actual size. Unfortunately, we have
8615 found some cases, such as in the Ada "integer" type, where
8616 this is not the case. Until this problem is solved, we need to
8617 keep checking the actual size. */
8618 tree type_name
= TYPE_NAME (type
);
8619 tree subtype_name
= TYPE_NAME (subtype
);
8621 if (type_name
!= NULL
&& TREE_CODE (type_name
) == TYPE_DECL
)
8622 type_name
= DECL_NAME (type_name
);
8624 if (subtype_name
!= NULL
&& TREE_CODE (subtype_name
) == TYPE_DECL
)
8625 subtype_name
= DECL_NAME (subtype_name
);
8627 if (type_name
== subtype_name
)
8634 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
8635 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
8638 subrange_type_die (tree type
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
8640 dw_die_ref subrange_die
;
8641 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes
= int_size_in_bytes (type
);
8643 if (context_die
== NULL
)
8644 context_die
= comp_unit_die
;
8646 subrange_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type
, context_die
, type
);
8648 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type
)) != size_in_bytes
)
8650 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
8651 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
8652 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die
, DW_AT_byte_size
, size_in_bytes
);
8655 if (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type
) != NULL
)
8656 add_bound_info (subrange_die
, DW_AT_lower_bound
,
8657 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type
));
8658 if (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type
) != NULL
)
8659 add_bound_info (subrange_die
, DW_AT_upper_bound
,
8660 TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type
));
8662 return subrange_die
;
8665 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
8666 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
8669 modified_type_die (tree type
, int is_const_type
, int is_volatile_type
,
8670 dw_die_ref context_die
)
8672 enum tree_code code
= TREE_CODE (type
);
8673 dw_die_ref mod_type_die
;
8674 dw_die_ref sub_die
= NULL
;
8675 tree item_type
= NULL
;
8676 tree qualified_type
;
8679 if (code
== ERROR_MARK
)
8682 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
8685 = get_qualified_type (type
,
8686 ((is_const_type
? TYPE_QUAL_CONST
: 0)
8687 | (is_volatile_type
? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE
: 0)));
8689 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
8692 mod_type_die
= lookup_type_die (qualified_type
);
8694 return mod_type_die
;
8697 name
= qualified_type
? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type
) : NULL
;
8699 /* Handle C typedef types. */
8700 if (name
&& TREE_CODE (name
) == TYPE_DECL
&& DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name
))
8702 tree dtype
= TREE_TYPE (name
);
8704 if (qualified_type
== dtype
)
8706 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
8707 gen_type_die (qualified_type
, context_die
);
8708 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type
);
8710 else if (is_const_type
< TYPE_READONLY (dtype
)
8711 || is_volatile_type
< TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype
)
8712 || (is_const_type
<= TYPE_READONLY (dtype
)
8713 && is_volatile_type
<= TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype
)
8714 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name
) != type
))
8715 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use the unnamed
8716 type to which it refers. */
8717 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name
),
8718 is_const_type
, is_volatile_type
,
8720 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
8725 mod_type_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_const_type
, comp_unit_die
, type
);
8726 sub_die
= modified_type_die (type
, 0, is_volatile_type
, context_die
);
8728 else if (is_volatile_type
)
8730 mod_type_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type
, comp_unit_die
, type
);
8731 sub_die
= modified_type_die (type
, 0, 0, context_die
);
8733 else if (code
== POINTER_TYPE
)
8735 mod_type_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type
, comp_unit_die
, type
);
8736 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die
, DW_AT_byte_size
,
8737 simple_type_size_in_bits (type
) / BITS_PER_UNIT
);
8738 item_type
= TREE_TYPE (type
);
8740 else if (code
== REFERENCE_TYPE
)
8742 mod_type_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type
, comp_unit_die
, type
);
8743 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die
, DW_AT_byte_size
,
8744 simple_type_size_in_bits (type
) / BITS_PER_UNIT
);
8745 item_type
= TREE_TYPE (type
);
8747 else if (is_subrange_type (type
))
8749 mod_type_die
= subrange_type_die (type
, context_die
);
8750 item_type
= TREE_TYPE (type
);
8752 else if (is_base_type (type
))
8753 mod_type_die
= base_type_die (type
);
8756 gen_type_die (type
, context_die
);
8758 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
8759 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
8760 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
8761 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
8762 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
8764 if (TREE_CODE (type
) != VECTOR_TYPE
)
8765 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type
));
8767 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
8768 not the main variant. */
8769 return lookup_type_die (type
);
8772 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
8773 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
8774 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type. */
8776 && (TREE_CODE (name
) != TYPE_DECL
8777 || (TREE_TYPE (name
) == qualified_type
&& DECL_NAME (name
))))
8779 if (TREE_CODE (name
) == TYPE_DECL
)
8780 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
8781 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
8782 useful source coordinates anyway. */
8783 name
= DECL_NAME (name
);
8784 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die
, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name
));
8788 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type
, mod_type_die
);
8791 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
8792 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
8793 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
8794 types are possible in Ada. */
8795 sub_die
= modified_type_die (item_type
,
8796 TYPE_READONLY (item_type
),
8797 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type
),
8800 if (sub_die
!= NULL
)
8801 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die
, DW_AT_type
, sub_die
);
8803 return mod_type_die
;
8806 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
8807 an enumerated type. */
8810 type_is_enum (const_tree type
)
8812 return TREE_CODE (type
) == ENUMERAL_TYPE
;
8815 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
8818 dbx_reg_number (const_rtx rtl
)
8820 unsigned regno
= REGNO (rtl
);
8822 gcc_assert (regno
< FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
);
8824 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8825 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
)
8827 int leaf_reg
= LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno
);
8829 regno
= (unsigned) leaf_reg
;
8833 return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno
);
8836 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
8837 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
8838 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
8841 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref
*list_head
, int size
)
8843 dw_loc_descr_ref loc
;
8845 if (*list_head
!= NULL
)
8847 /* Find the end of the chain. */
8848 for (loc
= *list_head
; loc
->dw_loc_next
!= NULL
; loc
= loc
->dw_loc_next
)
8851 if (loc
->dw_loc_opc
!= DW_OP_piece
)
8852 loc
->dw_loc_next
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece
, size
, 0);
8856 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
8857 zero if there is none. */
8859 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8860 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl
, enum var_init_status initialized
)
8864 if (REGNO (rtl
) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
8867 regs
= targetm
.dwarf_register_span (rtl
);
8869 if (hard_regno_nregs
[REGNO (rtl
)][GET_MODE (rtl
)] > 1 || regs
)
8870 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl
, regs
, initialized
);
8872 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (rtl
), initialized
);
8875 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
8876 a given hard register number. */
8878 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8879 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno
, enum var_init_status initialized
)
8881 dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descr
;
8883 reg_loc_descr
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0
+ regno
, 0, 0);
8885 reg_loc_descr
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx
, regno
, 0);
8887 if (initialized
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
)
8888 add_loc_descr (®_loc_descr
, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit
, 0, 0));
8890 return reg_loc_descr
;
8893 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
8894 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
8896 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8897 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl
, rtx regs
,
8898 enum var_init_status initialized
)
8902 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result
= NULL
;
8905 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8906 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
)
8908 int leaf_reg
= LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg
);
8910 reg
= (unsigned) leaf_reg
;
8913 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg
) == dbx_reg_number (rtl
));
8914 nregs
= hard_regno_nregs
[REGNO (rtl
)][GET_MODE (rtl
)];
8916 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
8917 if (regs
== NULL_RTX
)
8919 size
= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl
)) / nregs
;
8926 t
= one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg
),
8927 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
8928 add_loc_descr (&loc_result
, t
);
8929 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result
, size
);
8935 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
8937 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs
) == PARALLEL
);
8939 size
= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs
, 0, 0)));
8942 for (i
= 0; i
< XVECLEN (regs
, 0); ++i
)
8946 t
= one_reg_loc_descriptor (REGNO (XVECEXP (regs
, 0, i
)),
8947 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
8948 add_loc_descr (&loc_result
, t
);
8949 size
= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs
, 0, 0)));
8950 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result
, size
);
8953 if (loc_result
&& initialized
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
)
8954 add_loc_descr (&loc_result
, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit
, 0, 0));
8958 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
8960 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8961 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i
)
8963 enum dwarf_location_atom op
;
8965 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
8966 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
8970 op
= DW_OP_lit0
+ i
;
8973 else if (i
<= 0xffff)
8975 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
== 32
8985 else if (i
>= -0x8000)
8987 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
== 32
8988 || i
>= -0x80000000)
8994 return new_loc_descr (op
, i
, 0);
8997 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
8999 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9000 based_loc_descr (rtx reg
, HOST_WIDE_INT offset
,
9001 enum var_init_status initialized
)
9004 dw_loc_descr_ref result
;
9006 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
9007 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
9008 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
9009 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
9010 if (reg
== arg_pointer_rtx
|| reg
== frame_pointer_rtx
)
9012 rtx elim
= eliminate_regs (reg
, VOIDmode
, NULL_RTX
);
9016 if (GET_CODE (elim
) == PLUS
)
9018 offset
+= INTVAL (XEXP (elim
, 1));
9019 elim
= XEXP (elim
, 0);
9021 gcc_assert (elim
== (frame_pointer_needed
? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
9022 : stack_pointer_rtx
));
9023 offset
+= frame_pointer_fb_offset
;
9025 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg
, offset
, 0);
9029 regno
= dbx_reg_number (reg
);
9031 result
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0
+ regno
, offset
, 0);
9033 result
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx
, regno
, offset
);
9035 if (initialized
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
)
9036 add_loc_descr (&result
, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit
, 0, 0));
9041 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
9044 is_based_loc (const_rtx rtl
)
9046 return (GET_CODE (rtl
) == PLUS
9047 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl
, 0))
9048 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl
, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
9049 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl
, 1)) == CONST_INT
)));
9052 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N locations
9053 used to form the address of a memory location. */
9055 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9056 concatn_mem_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn
, enum machine_mode mode
,
9057 enum var_init_status initialized
)
9060 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result
= NULL
;
9061 unsigned int n
= XVECLEN (concatn
, 0);
9063 for (i
= 0; i
< n
; ++i
)
9065 dw_loc_descr_ref ref
;
9066 rtx x
= XVECEXP (concatn
, 0, i
);
9068 ref
= mem_loc_descriptor (x
, mode
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
9072 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result
, ref
);
9073 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result
, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x
)));
9076 if (cc_loc_result
&& initialized
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
)
9077 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result
, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit
, 0, 0));
9079 return cc_loc_result
;
9082 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
9083 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
9084 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
9085 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
9087 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
9088 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
9089 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
9090 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
9092 MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
9093 autoincrement addressing modes.
9095 CAN_USE_FBREG is a flag whether we can use DW_AT_frame_base in the
9096 location list for RTL.
9098 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
9100 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9101 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl
, enum machine_mode mode
,
9102 enum var_init_status initialized
)
9104 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result
= NULL
;
9105 enum dwarf_location_atom op
;
9107 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
9108 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
9109 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
9110 zeroth element of the array. */
9112 rtl
= targetm
.delegitimize_address (rtl
);
9114 switch (GET_CODE (rtl
))
9119 /* POST_INC and POST_DEC can be handled just like a SUBREG. So we
9120 just fall into the SUBREG code. */
9122 /* ... fall through ... */
9125 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
9126 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
9127 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
9128 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
9129 contains the given subreg. */
9130 rtl
= XEXP (rtl
, 0);
9132 /* ... fall through ... */
9135 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
9136 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
9137 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
9138 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
9139 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
9140 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
9141 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
9142 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
9143 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
9144 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
9145 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
9146 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
9147 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
9148 if (REGNO (rtl
) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
)
9149 mem_loc_result
= based_loc_descr (rtl
, 0, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
9153 mem_loc_result
= mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl
, 0), GET_MODE (rtl
),
9154 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
9155 if (mem_loc_result
!= 0)
9156 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result
, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref
, 0, 0));
9160 rtl
= XEXP (rtl
, 1);
9162 /* ... fall through ... */
9165 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
9166 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
9170 /* Alternatively, the symbol in the constant pool might be referenced
9171 by a different symbol. */
9172 if (GET_CODE (rtl
) == SYMBOL_REF
&& CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl
))
9175 rtx tmp
= get_pool_constant_mark (rtl
, &marked
);
9177 if (GET_CODE (tmp
) == SYMBOL_REF
)
9180 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (tmp
))
9181 get_pool_constant_mark (tmp
, &marked
);
9186 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
9187 it was not output and thus we can't represent it.
9188 FIXME: might try to use DW_OP_const_value here, though
9189 DW_OP_piece complicates it. */
9194 mem_loc_result
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr
, 0, 0);
9195 mem_loc_result
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.val_class
= dw_val_class_addr
;
9196 mem_loc_result
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_addr
= rtl
;
9197 VEC_safe_push (rtx
, gc
, used_rtx_array
, rtl
);
9201 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
9203 rtl
= XEXP (rtl
, 1);
9208 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
9210 rtl
= gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode
, XEXP (rtl
, 0),
9211 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl
) == PRE_INC
9212 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode
)
9213 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode
)));
9215 /* ... fall through ... */
9219 if (is_based_loc (rtl
))
9220 mem_loc_result
= based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl
, 0),
9221 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl
, 1)),
9222 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
9225 mem_loc_result
= mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl
, 0), mode
,
9226 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
9227 if (mem_loc_result
== 0)
9230 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl
, 1)) == CONST_INT
9231 && INTVAL (XEXP (rtl
, 1)) >= 0)
9232 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result
,
9233 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst
,
9234 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl
, 1)), 0));
9237 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result
,
9238 mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl
, 1), mode
,
9239 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
));
9240 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result
,
9241 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus
, 0, 0));
9246 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
9247 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
9266 dw_loc_descr_ref op0
= mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl
, 0), mode
,
9267 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
9268 dw_loc_descr_ref op1
= mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl
, 1), mode
,
9269 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
9271 if (op0
== 0 || op1
== 0)
9274 mem_loc_result
= op0
;
9275 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result
, op1
);
9276 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result
, new_loc_descr (op
, 0, 0));
9281 mem_loc_result
= int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl
));
9285 mem_loc_result
= concatn_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl
, mode
,
9286 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
9293 if (mem_loc_result
&& initialized
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
)
9294 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result
, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit
, 0, 0));
9296 return mem_loc_result
;
9299 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
9300 This is typically a complex variable. */
9302 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9303 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0
, rtx x1
, enum var_init_status initialized
)
9305 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result
= NULL
;
9306 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref
= loc_descriptor (x0
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
9307 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref
= loc_descriptor (x1
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
9309 if (x0_ref
== 0 || x1_ref
== 0)
9312 cc_loc_result
= x0_ref
;
9313 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result
, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0
)));
9315 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result
, x1_ref
);
9316 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result
, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1
)));
9318 if (initialized
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
)
9319 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result
, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit
, 0, 0));
9321 return cc_loc_result
;
9324 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N
9327 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9328 concatn_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn
, enum var_init_status initialized
)
9331 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result
= NULL
;
9332 unsigned int n
= XVECLEN (concatn
, 0);
9334 for (i
= 0; i
< n
; ++i
)
9336 dw_loc_descr_ref ref
;
9337 rtx x
= XVECEXP (concatn
, 0, i
);
9339 ref
= loc_descriptor (x
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
9343 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result
, ref
);
9344 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result
, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x
)));
9347 if (cc_loc_result
&& initialized
== VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED
)
9348 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result
, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit
, 0, 0));
9350 return cc_loc_result
;
9353 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
9354 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
9355 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
9356 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
9357 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
9359 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
9361 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9362 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl
, enum var_init_status initialized
)
9364 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result
= NULL
;
9366 switch (GET_CODE (rtl
))
9369 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
9370 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
9371 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
9372 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
9373 contains the given subreg. */
9374 rtl
= SUBREG_REG (rtl
);
9376 /* ... fall through ... */
9379 loc_result
= reg_loc_descriptor (rtl
, initialized
);
9383 loc_result
= mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl
, 0), GET_MODE (rtl
),
9388 loc_result
= concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl
, 0), XEXP (rtl
, 1),
9393 loc_result
= concatn_loc_descriptor (rtl
, initialized
);
9398 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl
, 1)) != PARALLEL
)
9400 loc_result
= loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (rtl
, 1), 0), initialized
);
9404 rtl
= XEXP (rtl
, 1);
9409 rtvec par_elems
= XVEC (rtl
, 0);
9410 int num_elem
= GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems
);
9411 enum machine_mode mode
;
9414 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
9415 loc_result
= loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems
, 0), 0),
9417 mode
= GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems
, 0), 0));
9418 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result
, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode
));
9419 for (i
= 1; i
< num_elem
; i
++)
9421 dw_loc_descr_ref temp
;
9423 temp
= loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems
, i
), 0),
9425 add_loc_descr (&loc_result
, temp
);
9426 mode
= GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems
, i
), 0));
9427 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result
, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode
));
9439 /* Similar, but generate the descriptor from trees instead of rtl. This comes
9440 up particularly with variable length arrays. WANT_ADDRESS is 2 if this is
9441 a top-level invocation of loc_descriptor_from_tree; is 1 if this is not a
9442 top-level invocation, and we require the address of LOC; is 0 if we require
9443 the value of LOC. */
9445 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9446 loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree loc
, int want_address
)
9448 dw_loc_descr_ref ret
, ret1
;
9449 int have_address
= 0;
9450 enum dwarf_location_atom op
;
9452 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
9453 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
9456 switch (TREE_CODE (loc
))
9461 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR
:
9462 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
9463 position of other fields. We don't try to encode this here. The
9464 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
9465 the names of types. */
9471 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR
:
9472 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR
:
9473 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR
:
9474 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR
:
9475 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
9479 /* If we already want an address, there's nothing we can do. */
9483 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
9484 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 0), 1);
9487 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc
))
9491 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
9492 if (!targetm
.have_tls
|| !targetm
.asm_out
.output_dwarf_dtprel
)
9495 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we can only
9496 look up addresses of objects in the current module. */
9497 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc
))
9500 rtl
= rtl_for_decl_location (loc
);
9501 if (rtl
== NULL_RTX
)
9506 rtl
= XEXP (rtl
, 0);
9507 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl
))
9510 ret
= new_loc_descr (INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr
, 0, 0);
9511 ret
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.val_class
= dw_val_class_addr
;
9512 ret
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_addr
= rtl
;
9514 ret1
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address
, 0, 0);
9515 add_loc_descr (&ret
, ret1
);
9523 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc
))
9524 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc
),
9531 rtx rtl
= rtl_for_decl_location (loc
);
9533 if (rtl
== NULL_RTX
)
9535 else if (GET_CODE (rtl
) == CONST_INT
)
9537 HOST_WIDE_INT val
= INTVAL (rtl
);
9538 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc
)))
9539 val
&= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc
));
9540 ret
= int_loc_descriptor (val
);
9542 else if (GET_CODE (rtl
) == CONST_STRING
)
9544 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl
))
9546 ret
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr
, 0, 0);
9547 ret
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.val_class
= dw_val_class_addr
;
9548 ret
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_addr
= rtl
;
9552 enum machine_mode mode
;
9554 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
9555 if (want_address
== 2)
9556 return loc_descriptor (rtl
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
9558 mode
= GET_MODE (rtl
);
9561 rtl
= XEXP (rtl
, 0);
9564 ret
= mem_loc_descriptor (rtl
, mode
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
9570 ret
= loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 0), 0);
9575 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 1), want_address
);
9579 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR
:
9580 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR
:
9582 case GIMPLE_MODIFY_STMT
:
9583 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (GENERIC_TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 0),
9589 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF
:
9592 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize
, bitpos
, bytepos
;
9593 enum machine_mode mode
;
9595 int unsignedp
= TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc
));
9597 obj
= get_inner_reference (loc
, &bitsize
, &bitpos
, &offset
, &mode
,
9598 &unsignedp
, &volatilep
, false);
9603 ret
= loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (obj
, 1);
9605 || bitpos
% BITS_PER_UNIT
!= 0 || bitsize
% BITS_PER_UNIT
!= 0)
9608 if (offset
!= NULL_TREE
)
9610 /* Variable offset. */
9611 add_loc_descr (&ret
, loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (offset
, 0));
9612 add_loc_descr (&ret
, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus
, 0, 0));
9615 bytepos
= bitpos
/ BITS_PER_UNIT
;
9617 add_loc_descr (&ret
, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst
, bytepos
, 0));
9618 else if (bytepos
< 0)
9620 add_loc_descr (&ret
, int_loc_descriptor (bytepos
));
9621 add_loc_descr (&ret
, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus
, 0, 0));
9629 if (host_integerp (loc
, 0))
9630 ret
= int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc
, 0));
9637 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
9638 rtx rtl
= lookup_constant_def (loc
);
9639 enum machine_mode mode
;
9641 if (!rtl
|| !MEM_P (rtl
))
9643 mode
= GET_MODE (rtl
);
9644 rtl
= XEXP (rtl
, 0);
9645 ret
= mem_loc_descriptor (rtl
, mode
, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
);
9650 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR
:
9651 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR
:
9656 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR
:
9662 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR
:
9667 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR
:
9669 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR
:
9670 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
:
9678 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR
:
9680 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR
:
9681 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR
:
9694 op
= (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc
)) ? DW_OP_shr
: DW_OP_shra
);
9697 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
:
9699 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
9700 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 1), 0))
9702 ret
= loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 0), 0);
9706 add_loc_descr (&ret
,
9707 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst
,
9708 tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 1),
9718 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 0))))
9725 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 0))))
9732 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 0))))
9739 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 0))))
9754 ret
= loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 0), 0);
9755 ret1
= loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 1), 0);
9756 if (ret
== 0 || ret1
== 0)
9759 add_loc_descr (&ret
, ret1
);
9760 add_loc_descr (&ret
, new_loc_descr (op
, 0, 0));
9763 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR
:
9777 ret
= loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 0), 0);
9781 add_loc_descr (&ret
, new_loc_descr (op
, 0, 0));
9787 const enum tree_code code
=
9788 TREE_CODE (loc
) == MIN_EXPR
? GT_EXPR
: LT_EXPR
;
9790 loc
= build3 (COND_EXPR
, TREE_TYPE (loc
),
9791 build2 (code
, integer_type_node
,
9792 TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 1)),
9793 TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 0));
9796 /* ... fall through ... */
9800 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
9801 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 1), 0);
9802 dw_loc_descr_ref rhs
9803 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 2), 0);
9804 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node
, jump_node
, tmp
;
9806 ret
= loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc
, 0), 0);
9807 if (ret
== 0 || lhs
== 0 || rhs
== 0)
9810 bra_node
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra
, 0, 0);
9811 add_loc_descr (&ret
, bra_node
);
9813 add_loc_descr (&ret
, rhs
);
9814 jump_node
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip
, 0, 0);
9815 add_loc_descr (&ret
, jump_node
);
9817 add_loc_descr (&ret
, lhs
);
9818 bra_node
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.val_class
= dw_val_class_loc
;
9819 bra_node
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_loc
= lhs
;
9821 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
9822 tmp
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop
, 0, 0);
9823 add_loc_descr (&ret
, tmp
);
9824 jump_node
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.val_class
= dw_val_class_loc
;
9825 jump_node
->dw_loc_oprnd1
.v
.val_loc
= tmp
;
9829 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR
:
9833 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
9834 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
9835 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc
)
9836 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE
)
9839 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
9840 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
9841 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
9844 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
9845 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
9850 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
9851 if (want_address
&& !have_address
)
9854 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
9855 if (!want_address
&& have_address
&& ret
)
9857 HOST_WIDE_INT size
= int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc
));
9859 if (size
> DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
|| size
== -1)
9861 else if (size
== DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
)
9864 op
= DW_OP_deref_size
;
9866 add_loc_descr (&ret
, new_loc_descr (op
, size
, 0));
9872 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
9873 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc
)
9875 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (loc
, 2);
9878 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
9879 which is not less than the value itself. */
9881 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
9882 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value
, unsigned int boundary
)
9884 return (((value
+ boundary
- 1) / boundary
) * boundary
);
9887 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
9888 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
9889 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
9893 field_type (const_tree decl
)
9897 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == ERROR_MARK
)
9898 return integer_type_node
;
9900 type
= DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl
);
9901 if (type
== NULL_TREE
)
9902 type
= TREE_TYPE (decl
);
9907 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
9908 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
9909 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
9911 static inline unsigned
9912 simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree type
)
9914 return (TREE_CODE (type
) != ERROR_MARK
) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type
) : BITS_PER_WORD
;
9917 static inline unsigned
9918 simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree decl
)
9920 return (TREE_CODE (decl
) != ERROR_MARK
) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl
) : BITS_PER_WORD
;
9923 /* Return the result of rounding T up to ALIGN. */
9925 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
9926 round_up_to_align (HOST_WIDE_INT t
, unsigned int align
)
9928 /* We must be careful if T is negative because HOST_WIDE_INT can be
9929 either "above" or "below" unsigned int as per the C promotion
9930 rules, depending on the host, thus making the signedness of the
9931 direct multiplication and division unpredictable. */
9932 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT u
= (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
) t
;
9938 return (HOST_WIDE_INT
) u
;
9941 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
9942 lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
9943 or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
9944 because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
9945 because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
9948 static HOST_WIDE_INT
9949 field_byte_offset (const_tree decl
)
9951 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bits
;
9952 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int
;
9954 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == ERROR_MARK
)
9957 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl
) == FIELD_DECL
);
9959 /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
9960 for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
9961 be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
9962 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl
), 0))
9965 bitpos_int
= int_bit_position (decl
);
9967 #ifdef PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
9968 if (PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
)
9971 tree field_size_tree
;
9972 HOST_WIDE_INT deepest_bitpos
;
9973 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT field_size_in_bits
;
9974 unsigned int type_align_in_bits
;
9975 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits
;
9976 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT type_size_in_bits
;
9978 type
= field_type (decl
);
9979 field_size_tree
= DECL_SIZE (decl
);
9981 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
9982 a flexible array member. */
9983 if (! field_size_tree
)
9984 field_size_tree
= bitsize_zero_node
;
9986 /* If we don't know the size of the field, pretend it's a full word. */
9987 if (host_integerp (field_size_tree
, 1))
9988 field_size_in_bits
= tree_low_cst (field_size_tree
, 1);
9990 field_size_in_bits
= BITS_PER_WORD
;
9992 type_size_in_bits
= simple_type_size_in_bits (type
);
9993 type_align_in_bits
= simple_type_align_in_bits (type
);
9994 decl_align_in_bits
= simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl
);
9996 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the
9997 starting bit offset (relative to the start of the containing
9998 structure type) of the hypothetical "containing object" for a
9999 bit-field. Thus, when computing the byte offset value for the
10000 start of the "containing object" of a bit-field, we must deduce
10001 this information on our own. This can be rather tricky to do in
10002 some cases. For example, handling the following structure type
10003 definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only
10004 aligns long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
10006 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
10008 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used
10009 in such cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will
10010 allocate 8 bytes for the structure shown above. It decides to
10011 do this based upon one simple rule for bit-field allocation.
10012 GCC allocates each "containing object" for each bit-field at
10013 the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment boundary
10014 (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared
10015 type of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the
10016 condition that there is still enough available space remaining
10017 in the containing object (when allocated at the selected point)
10018 to fully accommodate all of the bits of the bit-field itself.
10020 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for
10021 each object of the structure type shown above. When looking
10022 for a place to allocate the "containing object" for `field2',
10023 the compiler simply tries to allocate a 64-bit "containing
10024 object" at each successive 32-bit boundary (starting at zero)
10025 until it finds a place to allocate that 64- bit field such that
10026 at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated) bits remain
10027 within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
10028 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the
10029 "containing object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the
10032 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts
10033 we're given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC
10034 must have believed that the containing object started (within
10035 the structure type). The value we deduce is then used (by the
10036 callers of this routine) to generate DW_AT_location and
10037 DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields and, in
10038 the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
10040 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to
10041 the "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
10042 deepest_bitpos
= bitpos_int
+ field_size_in_bits
;
10044 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce
10045 where the lowest addressed bit of the containing object must
10047 object_offset_in_bits
= deepest_bitpos
- type_size_in_bits
;
10049 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for
10051 object_offset_in_bits
10052 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits
, type_align_in_bits
);
10054 if (object_offset_in_bits
> bitpos_int
)
10056 object_offset_in_bits
= deepest_bitpos
- type_size_in_bits
;
10058 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
10059 object_offset_in_bits
10060 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits
, decl_align_in_bits
);
10065 object_offset_in_bits
= bitpos_int
;
10067 return object_offset_in_bits
/ BITS_PER_UNIT
;
10070 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
10071 associated with them. */
10073 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
10075 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
10076 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
10077 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
10080 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind
,
10081 dw_loc_descr_ref descr
)
10084 add_AT_loc (die
, attr_kind
, descr
);
10087 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
10088 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
10089 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
10090 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
10091 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
10092 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
10095 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
10096 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
10097 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
10098 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
10099 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
10100 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
10101 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
10102 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
10103 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
10104 function below.) */
10107 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die
, tree decl
)
10109 HOST_WIDE_INT offset
;
10110 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr
= 0;
10112 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == TREE_BINFO
)
10114 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
10115 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl
) && is_cxx ())
10117 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
10118 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
10119 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
10120 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
10122 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
10124 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
10126 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp
;
10128 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
10129 tmp
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup
, 0, 0);
10130 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr
, tmp
);
10132 /* Extract the vtable address. */
10133 tmp
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref
, 0, 0);
10134 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr
, tmp
);
10136 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
10137 offset
= tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl
), 0);
10138 gcc_assert (offset
< 0);
10140 tmp
= int_loc_descriptor (-offset
);
10141 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr
, tmp
);
10142 tmp
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus
, 0, 0);
10143 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr
, tmp
);
10145 /* Extract the offset. */
10146 tmp
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref
, 0, 0);
10147 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr
, tmp
);
10149 /* Add it to the object address. */
10150 tmp
= new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus
, 0, 0);
10151 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr
, tmp
);
10154 offset
= tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl
), 0);
10157 offset
= field_byte_offset (decl
);
10161 enum dwarf_location_atom op
;
10163 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
10164 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure field
10165 address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
10167 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10168 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
10169 operator correctly. It works only if we leave the offset on the
10173 op
= DW_OP_plus_uconst
;
10176 loc_descr
= new_loc_descr (op
, offset
, 0);
10179 add_AT_loc (die
, DW_AT_data_member_location
, loc_descr
);
10182 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
10185 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val
, unsigned int size
, unsigned char *dest
)
10189 *dest
++ = val
& 0xff;
10195 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
10197 static HOST_WIDE_INT
10198 extract_int (const unsigned char *src
, unsigned int size
)
10200 HOST_WIDE_INT val
= 0;
10206 val
|= *--src
& 0xff;
10212 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
10215 insert_float (const_rtx rtl
, unsigned char *array
)
10217 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv
;
10221 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv
, rtl
);
10222 real_to_target (val
, &rv
, GET_MODE (rtl
));
10224 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
10225 for (i
= 0; i
< GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl
)) / 4; i
++)
10227 insert_int (val
[i
], 4, array
);
10232 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
10233 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
10234 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
10235 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
10236 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
10239 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die
, rtx rtl
)
10241 switch (GET_CODE (rtl
))
10245 HOST_WIDE_INT val
= INTVAL (rtl
);
10248 add_AT_int (die
, DW_AT_const_value
, val
);
10250 add_AT_unsigned (die
, DW_AT_const_value
, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
) val
);
10255 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
10256 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
10257 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
10258 represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
10260 enum machine_mode mode
= GET_MODE (rtl
);
10262 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode
))
10264 unsigned int length
= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode
);
10265 unsigned char *array
= ggc_alloc (length
);
10267 insert_float (rtl
, array
);
10268 add_AT_vec (die
, DW_AT_const_value
, length
/ 4, 4, array
);
10272 /* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout. */
10273 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG
== HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
);
10275 add_AT_long_long (die
, DW_AT_const_value
,
10276 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl
), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl
));
10283 enum machine_mode mode
= GET_MODE (rtl
);
10284 unsigned int elt_size
= GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode
);
10285 unsigned int length
= CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl
);
10286 unsigned char *array
= ggc_alloc (length
* elt_size
);
10290 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode
))
10292 case MODE_VECTOR_INT
:
10293 for (i
= 0, p
= array
; i
< length
; i
++, p
+= elt_size
)
10295 rtx elt
= CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl
, i
);
10296 HOST_WIDE_INT lo
, hi
;
10298 switch (GET_CODE (elt
))
10306 lo
= CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (elt
);
10307 hi
= CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (elt
);
10311 gcc_unreachable ();
10314 if (elt_size
<= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT
))
10315 insert_int (lo
, elt_size
, p
);
10318 unsigned char *p0
= p
;
10319 unsigned char *p1
= p
+ sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT
);
10321 gcc_assert (elt_size
== 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT
));
10322 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
)
10327 insert_int (lo
, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT
), p0
);
10328 insert_int (hi
, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT
), p1
);
10333 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT
:
10334 for (i
= 0, p
= array
; i
< length
; i
++, p
+= elt_size
)
10336 rtx elt
= CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl
, i
);
10337 insert_float (elt
, p
);
10342 gcc_unreachable ();
10345 add_AT_vec (die
, DW_AT_const_value
, length
, elt_size
, array
);
10350 add_AT_string (die
, DW_AT_const_value
, XSTR (rtl
, 0));
10356 add_AT_addr (die
, DW_AT_const_value
, rtl
);
10357 VEC_safe_push (rtx
, gc
, used_rtx_array
, rtl
);
10361 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
10362 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
10363 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
10364 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
10365 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
10366 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
10367 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
10368 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
10369 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
10370 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
10371 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
10375 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
10376 gcc_unreachable ();
10381 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
10382 or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
10385 reference_to_unused (tree
* tp
, int * walk_subtrees
,
10386 void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
10388 if (! EXPR_P (*tp
) && ! GIMPLE_STMT_P (*tp
) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp
))
10389 *walk_subtrees
= 0;
10391 if (DECL_P (*tp
) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp
) && ! TREE_USED (*tp
)
10392 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp
))
10394 else if (!flag_unit_at_a_time
)
10396 /* ??? The C++ FE emits debug information for using decls, so
10397 putting gcc_unreachable here falls over. See PR31899. For now
10398 be conservative. */
10399 else if (!cgraph_global_info_ready
10400 && (TREE_CODE (*tp
) == VAR_DECL
|| TREE_CODE (*tp
) == FUNCTION_DECL
))
10402 else if (DECL_P (*tp
) && TREE_CODE (*tp
) == VAR_DECL
)
10404 struct varpool_node
*node
= varpool_node (*tp
);
10408 else if (DECL_P (*tp
) && TREE_CODE (*tp
) == FUNCTION_DECL
10409 && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp
) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp
)))
10411 struct cgraph_node
*node
= cgraph_node (*tp
);
10415 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp
) == STRING_CST
&& !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp
))
10421 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
10422 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
10425 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init
, tree type
)
10427 rtx rtl
= NULL_RTX
;
10429 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
10430 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
10431 if (TREE_CODE (init
) == STRING_CST
&& TREE_CODE (type
) == ARRAY_TYPE
)
10433 tree enttype
= TREE_TYPE (type
);
10434 tree domain
= TYPE_DOMAIN (type
);
10435 enum machine_mode mode
= TYPE_MODE (enttype
);
10437 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode
) == MODE_INT
&& GET_MODE_SIZE (mode
) == 1
10439 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain
))
10440 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain
),
10441 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init
) - 1) == 0
10442 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init
)
10443 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init
)) + 1))
10444 rtl
= gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode
,
10445 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init
)));
10447 /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
10449 else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type
) || TREE_CODE (type
) == COMPLEX_TYPE
)
10451 /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
10452 FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too. */
10453 else if (TREE_CODE (type
) == VECTOR_TYPE
&& TYPE_MODE (type
) == BLKmode
)
10455 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
10456 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. We must be careful not to
10457 reference variables which won't be output. */
10458 else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init
, type
)
10459 && ! walk_tree (&init
, reference_to_unused
, NULL
, NULL
))
10461 /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
10463 if (TREE_CODE (type
) == VECTOR_TYPE
)
10464 switch (TREE_CODE (init
))
10469 if (TREE_CONSTANT (init
))
10471 VEC(constructor_elt
,gc
) *elts
= CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init
);
10472 bool constant_p
= true;
10474 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix
;
10476 /* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
10477 elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
10478 belong into VECTOR_CST nodes. */
10479 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts
, ix
, value
)
10480 if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value
))
10482 constant_p
= false;
10488 init
= build_vector_from_ctor (type
, elts
);
10498 rtl
= expand_expr (init
, NULL_RTX
, VOIDmode
, EXPAND_INITIALIZER
);
10500 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
10501 gcc_assert (!rtl
|| !MEM_P (rtl
));
10507 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
10510 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl
)
10514 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
10515 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
10516 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
10518 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
10519 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
10520 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
10521 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
10522 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
10523 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
10524 referenced within the function.
10526 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
10527 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
10528 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
10529 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
10531 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
10532 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
10533 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
10534 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
10535 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
10536 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
10538 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
10539 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
10540 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
10541 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
10542 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
10543 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
10544 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
10545 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
10546 output at debug-time.
10548 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
10549 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
10550 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
10551 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
10552 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
10553 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
10554 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
10555 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
10556 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
10557 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
10558 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
10559 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
10560 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
10562 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
10563 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
10564 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
10565 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
10566 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
10567 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
10568 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
10569 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
10570 I'd like to fix it.
10572 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
10573 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
10574 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
10575 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
10576 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
10577 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
10578 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
10579 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
10580 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
10581 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
10582 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
10584 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
10585 rtl
= DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl
);
10587 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
10588 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
10589 fixed registers. */
10590 if (! reload_completed
)
10593 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl
)
10595 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl
, 0)))
10597 && TREE_CODE (decl
) == VAR_DECL
10598 && TREE_STATIC (decl
))))
10600 rtl
= targetm
.delegitimize_address (rtl
);
10605 else if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == PARM_DECL
)
10607 if (rtl
== NULL_RTX
|| is_pseudo_reg (rtl
))
10609 tree declared_type
= TREE_TYPE (decl
);
10610 tree passed_type
= DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl
);
10611 enum machine_mode dmode
= TYPE_MODE (declared_type
);
10612 enum machine_mode pmode
= TYPE_MODE (passed_type
);
10614 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
10615 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
10616 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
10617 if (dmode
== pmode
)
10618 rtl
= DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl
);
10619 else if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode
)
10620 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode
) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode
)
10621 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl
))
10623 rtx inc
= DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl
);
10626 else if (MEM_P (inc
))
10628 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
)
10629 rtl
= adjust_address_nv (inc
, dmode
,
10630 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode
)
10631 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode
));
10638 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
10639 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
10640 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
10641 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
10642 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
10643 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
10645 else if (MEM_P (rtl
)
10646 && XEXP (rtl
, 0) != const0_rtx
10647 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl
, 0))
10648 /* Not passed in memory. */
10649 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl
))
10650 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
10651 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl
, 0))
10652 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl
, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10653 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl
, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
10654 #if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10655 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl
, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
10658 /* Big endian correction check. */
10659 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10660 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl
)) != GET_MODE (rtl
)
10661 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl
)))
10664 int offset
= (UNITS_PER_WORD
10665 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl
))));
10667 rtl
= gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl
)),
10668 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl
, 0), offset
));
10671 else if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == VAR_DECL
10674 && GET_MODE (rtl
) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl
))
10675 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
)
10677 int rsize
= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl
));
10678 int dsize
= GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl
)));
10680 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
10681 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
10682 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
10683 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
10684 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
10685 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
10687 rtl
= gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl
)),
10688 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl
, 0), rsize
-dsize
));
10691 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
10692 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
10693 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
10694 if (!rtl
&& TREE_CODE (decl
) == VAR_DECL
&& DECL_INITIAL (decl
))
10695 rtl
= rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl
), TREE_TYPE (decl
));
10698 rtl
= targetm
.delegitimize_address (rtl
);
10700 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
10701 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
10702 code, and thus is not emitted. */
10704 rtl
= avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl
);
10709 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
10710 address ranges where a given location is valid.
10711 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
10712 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
10713 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
10714 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
10716 static const char *
10717 secname_for_decl (const_tree decl
)
10719 const char *secname
;
10721 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl
) && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl
))
10723 tree sectree
= DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl
);
10724 secname
= TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree
);
10726 else if (current_function_decl
&& DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl
))
10728 tree sectree
= DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl
);
10729 secname
= TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree
);
10731 else if (cfun
&& in_cold_section_p
)
10732 secname
= cfun
->cold_section_label
;
10734 secname
= text_section_label
;
10739 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
10740 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
10741 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
10742 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
10743 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
10744 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
10745 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
10746 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
10747 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
10748 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address. */
10751 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die
, tree decl
,
10752 enum dwarf_attribute attr
)
10755 dw_loc_descr_ref descr
;
10756 var_loc_list
*loc_list
;
10757 struct var_loc_node
*node
;
10758 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == ERROR_MARK
)
10761 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl
) == VAR_DECL
|| TREE_CODE (decl
) == PARM_DECL
10762 || TREE_CODE (decl
) == RESULT_DECL
);
10764 /* See if we possibly have multiple locations for this variable. */
10765 loc_list
= lookup_decl_loc (decl
);
10767 /* If it truly has multiple locations, the first and last node will
10769 if (loc_list
&& loc_list
->first
!= loc_list
->last
)
10771 const char *endname
, *secname
;
10772 dw_loc_list_ref list
;
10774 enum var_init_status initialized
;
10776 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
10777 actually construct the list of locations.
10778 The first location information is what is passed to the
10779 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
10780 locations just get added on to that list.
10781 Note that we only know the start address for a location
10782 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
10783 the range [current location start, next location start].
10784 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
10785 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
10787 node
= loc_list
->first
;
10788 varloc
= NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node
->var_loc_note
);
10789 secname
= secname_for_decl (decl
);
10791 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node
->var_loc_note
))
10792 initialized
= NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node
->var_loc_note
);
10794 initialized
= VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED
;
10796 list
= new_loc_list (loc_descriptor (varloc
, initialized
),
10797 node
->label
, node
->next
->label
, secname
, 1);
10800 for (; node
->next
; node
= node
->next
)
10801 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node
->var_loc_note
) != NULL_RTX
)
10803 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
10804 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
10805 enum var_init_status initialized
=
10806 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node
->var_loc_note
);
10807 varloc
= NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node
->var_loc_note
);
10808 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list
,
10809 loc_descriptor (varloc
, initialized
),
10810 node
->label
, node
->next
->label
, secname
);
10813 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
10814 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
10815 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node
->var_loc_note
) != NULL_RTX
)
10817 char label_id
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
10818 enum var_init_status initialized
=
10819 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node
->var_loc_note
);
10821 varloc
= NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node
->var_loc_note
);
10822 if (!current_function_decl
)
10823 endname
= text_end_label
;
10826 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id
, FUNC_END_LABEL
,
10827 current_function_funcdef_no
);
10828 endname
= ggc_strdup (label_id
);
10830 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list
,
10831 loc_descriptor (varloc
, initialized
),
10832 node
->label
, endname
, secname
);
10835 /* Finally, add the location list to the DIE, and we are done. */
10836 add_AT_loc_list (die
, attr
, list
);
10840 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
10843 rtl
= rtl_for_decl_location (decl
);
10844 if (rtl
&& (CONSTANT_P (rtl
) || GET_CODE (rtl
) == CONST_STRING
))
10846 add_const_value_attribute (die
, rtl
);
10850 /* If we have tried to generate the location otherwise, and it
10851 didn't work out (we wouldn't be here if we did), and we have a one entry
10852 location list, try generating a location from that. */
10853 if (loc_list
&& loc_list
->first
)
10855 enum var_init_status status
;
10856 node
= loc_list
->first
;
10857 status
= NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node
->var_loc_note
);
10858 descr
= loc_descriptor (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node
->var_loc_note
), status
);
10861 add_AT_location_description (die
, attr
, descr
);
10866 /* We couldn't get any rtl, so try directly generating the location
10867 description from the tree. */
10868 descr
= loc_descriptor_from_tree (decl
);
10871 add_AT_location_description (die
, attr
, descr
);
10874 /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
10875 try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL. */
10876 tree_add_const_value_attribute (die
, decl
);
10879 /* If we don't have a copy of this variable in memory for some reason (such
10880 as a C++ member constant that doesn't have an out-of-line definition),
10881 we should tell the debugger about the constant value. */
10884 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref var_die
, tree decl
)
10886 tree init
= DECL_INITIAL (decl
);
10887 tree type
= TREE_TYPE (decl
);
10890 if (TREE_READONLY (decl
) && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl
) && init
)
10895 rtl
= rtl_for_decl_init (init
, type
);
10897 add_const_value_attribute (var_die
, rtl
);
10900 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
10901 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
10902 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
10903 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
10906 static dw_loc_list_ref
10907 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset
)
10910 dw_loc_list_ref list
, *list_tail
;
10912 dw_cfa_location last_cfa
, next_cfa
;
10913 const char *start_label
, *last_label
, *section
;
10915 fde
= &fde_table
[fde_table_in_use
- 1];
10917 section
= secname_for_decl (current_function_decl
);
10921 next_cfa
.reg
= INVALID_REGNUM
;
10922 next_cfa
.offset
= 0;
10923 next_cfa
.indirect
= 0;
10924 next_cfa
.base_offset
= 0;
10926 start_label
= fde
->dw_fde_begin
;
10928 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
10929 advance opcodes. */
10930 for (cfi
= cie_cfi_head
; cfi
; cfi
= cfi
->dw_cfi_next
)
10931 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi
, &next_cfa
);
10933 last_cfa
= next_cfa
;
10934 last_label
= start_label
;
10936 for (cfi
= fde
->dw_fde_cfi
; cfi
; cfi
= cfi
->dw_cfi_next
)
10937 switch (cfi
->dw_cfi_opc
)
10939 case DW_CFA_set_loc
:
10940 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1
:
10941 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2
:
10942 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4
:
10943 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa
, &next_cfa
))
10945 *list_tail
= new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa
, offset
),
10946 start_label
, last_label
, section
,
10949 list_tail
= &(*list_tail
)->dw_loc_next
;
10950 last_cfa
= next_cfa
;
10951 start_label
= last_label
;
10953 last_label
= cfi
->dw_cfi_oprnd1
.dw_cfi_addr
;
10956 case DW_CFA_advance_loc
:
10957 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
10958 case DW_CFA_remember_state
:
10959 case DW_CFA_restore_state
:
10960 /* We don't handle these two in this function. It would be possible
10961 if it were to be required. */
10962 gcc_unreachable ();
10965 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi
, &next_cfa
);
10969 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa
, &next_cfa
))
10971 *list_tail
= new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa
, offset
),
10972 start_label
, last_label
, section
,
10974 list_tail
= &(*list_tail
)->dw_loc_next
;
10975 start_label
= last_label
;
10977 *list_tail
= new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa
, offset
),
10978 start_label
, fde
->dw_fde_end
, section
,
10984 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
10985 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
10986 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
10987 before the latter is negated. */
10990 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset
)
10994 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
10995 reg
= frame_pointer_rtx
;
10996 offset
+= FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl
);
10998 reg
= arg_pointer_rtx
;
10999 offset
+= ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl
);
11002 elim
= eliminate_regs (reg
, VOIDmode
, NULL_RTX
);
11003 if (GET_CODE (elim
) == PLUS
)
11005 offset
+= INTVAL (XEXP (elim
, 1));
11006 elim
= XEXP (elim
, 0);
11008 gcc_assert (elim
== (frame_pointer_needed
? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
11009 : stack_pointer_rtx
));
11011 frame_pointer_fb_offset
= -offset
;
11014 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
11015 the value of the attribute. */
11018 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die
, const char *name_string
)
11020 if (name_string
!= NULL
&& *name_string
!= 0)
11022 if (demangle_name_func
)
11023 name_string
= (*demangle_name_func
) (name_string
);
11025 add_AT_string (die
, DW_AT_name
, name_string
);
11029 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
11032 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die
)
11034 const char *wd
= get_src_pwd ();
11036 add_AT_string (die
, DW_AT_comp_dir
, remap_debug_filename (wd
));
11039 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
11040 a representation for that bound. */
11043 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die
, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr
, tree bound
)
11045 switch (TREE_CODE (bound
))
11050 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. */
11052 if (! host_integerp (bound
, 0)
11053 || (bound_attr
== DW_AT_lower_bound
11054 && (((is_c_family () || is_java ()) && integer_zerop (bound
))
11055 || (is_fortran () && integer_onep (bound
)))))
11056 /* Use the default. */
11059 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die
, bound_attr
, tree_low_cst (bound
, 0));
11064 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR
:
11065 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR
:
11066 add_bound_info (subrange_die
, bound_attr
, TREE_OPERAND (bound
, 0));
11076 dw_die_ref decl_die
= lookup_decl_die (bound
);
11078 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
11079 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
11080 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
11081 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
11082 later parameter. */
11083 if (decl_die
!= NULL
)
11084 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die
, bound_attr
, decl_die
);
11090 /* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
11091 evaluate the value of the array bound. */
11093 dw_die_ref ctx
, decl_die
;
11094 dw_loc_descr_ref loc
;
11096 loc
= loc_descriptor_from_tree (bound
);
11100 if (current_function_decl
== 0)
11101 ctx
= comp_unit_die
;
11103 ctx
= lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl
);
11105 decl_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_variable
, ctx
, bound
);
11106 add_AT_flag (decl_die
, DW_AT_artificial
, 1);
11107 add_type_attribute (decl_die
, TREE_TYPE (bound
), 1, 0, ctx
);
11108 add_AT_loc (decl_die
, DW_AT_location
, loc
);
11110 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die
, bound_attr
, decl_die
);
11116 /* Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
11117 includes information about the element type of type given array type. */
11120 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die
, tree type
)
11122 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11123 unsigned dimension_number
;
11126 dw_die_ref subrange_die
;
11128 /* The GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of
11129 one dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array
11130 types. Here we squish that down, so that each multidimensional array
11131 type gets only one array_type DIE in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft
11132 Dwarf specification say that we are allowed to do this kind of
11133 compression in C (because there is no difference between an array or
11134 arrays and a multidimensional array in C) but for other source languages
11135 (e.g. Ada) we probably shouldn't do this. */
11137 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
11138 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
11139 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
11140 gen_array_type_die. */
11141 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11142 for (dimension_number
= 0;
11143 TREE_CODE (type
) == ARRAY_TYPE
;
11144 type
= TREE_TYPE (type
), dimension_number
++)
11147 tree domain
= TYPE_DOMAIN (type
);
11149 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
11150 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
11152 subrange_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type
, type_die
, NULL
);
11155 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
11156 lower
= TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain
);
11157 upper
= TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain
);
11159 /* Define the index type. */
11160 if (TREE_TYPE (domain
))
11162 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
11163 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
11164 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
11165 if (TREE_CODE (domain
) == INTEGER_TYPE
11166 && TYPE_NAME (domain
) == NULL_TREE
11167 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain
)) == INTEGER_TYPE
11168 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain
)) == NULL_TREE
)
11171 add_type_attribute (subrange_die
, TREE_TYPE (domain
), 0, 0,
11175 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
11176 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
11178 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
11179 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
11180 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
11182 add_bound_info (subrange_die
, DW_AT_lower_bound
, lower
);
11184 add_bound_info (subrange_die
, DW_AT_upper_bound
, upper
);
11187 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
11188 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
11194 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die
, tree tree_node
)
11198 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node
))
11203 case ENUMERAL_TYPE
:
11206 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE
:
11207 size
= int_size_in_bytes (tree_node
);
11210 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
11211 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
11212 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
11213 even for bit-fields. */
11214 size
= simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node
)) / BITS_PER_UNIT
;
11217 gcc_unreachable ();
11220 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
11221 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
11222 have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time,
11223 so just let the -1 pass on through. */
11224 add_AT_unsigned (die
, DW_AT_byte_size
, size
);
11227 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
11228 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
11229 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
11232 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
11233 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
11234 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
11235 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
11236 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
11237 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
11239 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
11240 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
11241 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
11244 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die
, tree decl
)
11246 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes
= field_byte_offset (decl
);
11247 tree type
= DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl
);
11248 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int
;
11249 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset
;
11250 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset
;
11251 HOST_WIDE_INT
unsigned bit_offset
;
11253 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
11254 gcc_assert (type
&& TREE_CODE (decl
) == FIELD_DECL
);
11256 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
11257 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
11258 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
11259 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl
), 0)
11260 || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl
), 1))
11263 bitpos_int
= int_bit_position (decl
);
11265 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
11266 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
11267 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
11268 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
11269 below must take account of these differences. */
11270 highest_order_object_bit_offset
= object_offset_in_bytes
* BITS_PER_UNIT
;
11271 highest_order_field_bit_offset
= bitpos_int
;
11273 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
)
11275 highest_order_field_bit_offset
+= tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl
), 0);
11276 highest_order_object_bit_offset
+= simple_type_size_in_bits (type
);
11280 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
11281 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset
- highest_order_field_bit_offset
11282 : highest_order_field_bit_offset
- highest_order_object_bit_offset
);
11284 add_AT_unsigned (die
, DW_AT_bit_offset
, bit_offset
);
11287 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
11288 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
11291 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die
, tree decl
)
11293 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
11294 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl
) == FIELD_DECL
11295 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl
));
11297 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl
), 1))
11298 add_AT_unsigned (die
, DW_AT_bit_size
, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl
), 1));
11301 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
11302 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
11305 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die
, tree func_type
)
11307 if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die
, DW_AT_language
) == DW_LANG_C89
11308 && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type
) != NULL
)
11309 add_AT_flag (die
, DW_AT_prototyped
, 1);
11312 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
11313 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
11317 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die
, tree origin
)
11319 dw_die_ref origin_die
= NULL
;
11321 if (TREE_CODE (origin
) != FUNCTION_DECL
)
11323 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
11324 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
11325 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
11327 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
11328 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
11332 fn
= TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn
);
11334 fn
= decl_function_context (fn
);
11336 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn
);
11339 if (DECL_P (origin
))
11340 origin_die
= lookup_decl_die (origin
);
11341 else if (TYPE_P (origin
))
11342 origin_die
= lookup_type_die (origin
);
11344 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
11345 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
11346 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
11347 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
11348 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
11349 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
11350 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
11354 add_AT_die_ref (die
, DW_AT_abstract_origin
, origin_die
);
11357 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
11360 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die
, tree func_decl
)
11362 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl
))
11364 add_AT_unsigned (die
, DW_AT_virtuality
, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual
);
11366 if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl
), 0))
11367 add_AT_loc (die
, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location
,
11368 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu
,
11369 tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl
), 0),
11372 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
11373 if (debug_info_level
> DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
)
11374 add_AT_die_ref (die
, DW_AT_containing_type
,
11375 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl
)));
11379 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
11382 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die
, tree decl
)
11384 expanded_location s
= expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl
));
11386 add_AT_file (die
, DW_AT_decl_file
, lookup_filename (s
.file
));
11387 add_AT_unsigned (die
, DW_AT_decl_line
, s
.line
);
11390 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
11391 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
11394 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die
, tree decl
)
11398 decl_name
= DECL_NAME (decl
);
11399 if (decl_name
!= NULL
&& IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name
) != NULL
)
11401 add_name_attribute (die
, dwarf2_name (decl
, 0));
11402 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl
))
11403 add_src_coords_attributes (die
, decl
);
11405 if ((TREE_CODE (decl
) == FUNCTION_DECL
|| TREE_CODE (decl
) == VAR_DECL
)
11406 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl
)
11407 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl
) != DECL_NAME (decl
)
11408 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl
)
11409 && !(TREE_CODE (decl
) == VAR_DECL
&& DECL_REGISTER (decl
))
11411 add_AT_string (die
, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name
,
11412 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl
)));
11415 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11416 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
11417 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
11418 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == FUNCTION_DECL
&& TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl
))
11420 add_AT_addr (die
, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address
,
11421 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl
), 0));
11422 VEC_safe_push (tree
, gc
, used_rtx_array
, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl
), 0));
11427 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
11430 push_decl_scope (tree scope
)
11432 VEC_safe_push (tree
, gc
, decl_scope_table
, scope
);
11435 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
11438 pop_decl_scope (void)
11440 VEC_pop (tree
, decl_scope_table
);
11443 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
11444 Non-named types get global scope. Named types nested in other
11445 types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
11446 otherwise. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
11447 the current active scope. */
11450 scope_die_for (tree t
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
11452 dw_die_ref scope_die
= NULL
;
11453 tree containing_scope
;
11456 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
11457 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t
));
11459 containing_scope
= TYPE_CONTEXT (t
);
11461 /* Use the containing namespace if it was passed in (for a declaration). */
11462 if (containing_scope
&& TREE_CODE (containing_scope
) == NAMESPACE_DECL
)
11464 if (context_die
== lookup_decl_die (containing_scope
))
11467 containing_scope
= NULL_TREE
;
11470 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
11471 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
11472 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
11473 if (containing_scope
&& TREE_CODE (containing_scope
) == FUNCTION_TYPE
)
11474 containing_scope
= NULL_TREE
;
11476 if (containing_scope
== NULL_TREE
)
11477 scope_die
= comp_unit_die
;
11478 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope
))
11480 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. But
11481 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
11482 so we know where the new DIE should go. */
11483 for (i
= VEC_length (tree
, decl_scope_table
) - 1; i
>= 0; --i
)
11484 if (VEC_index (tree
, decl_scope_table
, i
) == containing_scope
)
11489 gcc_assert (debug_info_level
<= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
11490 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope
));
11492 /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope. */
11493 scope_die
= comp_unit_die
;
11496 scope_die
= lookup_type_die (containing_scope
);
11499 scope_die
= context_die
;
11504 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
11507 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die
)
11509 for (; context_die
; context_die
= context_die
->die_parent
)
11510 if (context_die
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
11511 || context_die
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_subprogram
)
11517 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
11518 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
11521 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die
)
11523 return (context_die
11524 && (context_die
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_structure_type
11525 || context_die
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_class_type
11526 || context_die
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_interface_type
11527 || context_die
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_union_type
11528 || context_die
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_namespace
));
11531 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
11532 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
11533 by 'type', and adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
11536 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die
, tree type
, int decl_const
,
11537 int decl_volatile
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
11539 enum tree_code code
= TREE_CODE (type
);
11540 dw_die_ref type_die
= NULL
;
11542 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral, floating-point
11543 or fixed-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
11544 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
11545 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
11546 if ((code
== INTEGER_TYPE
|| code
== REAL_TYPE
|| code
== FIXED_POINT_TYPE
)
11547 && TREE_TYPE (type
) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type
) == 0)
11548 type
= TREE_TYPE (type
), code
= TREE_CODE (type
);
11550 if (code
== ERROR_MARK
11551 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
11552 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
11553 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
11554 || code
== VOID_TYPE
)
11557 type_die
= modified_type_die (type
,
11558 decl_const
|| TYPE_READONLY (type
),
11559 decl_volatile
|| TYPE_VOLATILE (type
),
11562 if (type_die
!= NULL
)
11563 add_AT_die_ref (object_die
, DW_AT_type
, type_die
);
11566 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
11567 function call type. */
11569 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die
, tree decl
)
11571 enum dwarf_calling_convention value
= DW_CC_normal
;
11573 value
= targetm
.dwarf_calling_convention (TREE_TYPE (decl
));
11575 /* DWARF doesn't provide a way to identify a program's source-level
11576 entry point. DW_AT_calling_convention attributes are only meant
11577 to describe functions' calling conventions. However, lacking a
11578 better way to signal the Fortran main program, we use this for the
11579 time being, following existing custom. */
11581 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl
)), "MAIN__"))
11582 value
= DW_CC_program
;
11584 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
11585 is not DW_CC_normal. */
11586 if (value
&& (value
!= DW_CC_normal
))
11587 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die
, DW_AT_calling_convention
, value
);
11590 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
11591 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
11592 was declared without a tag. */
11594 static const char *
11595 type_tag (const_tree type
)
11597 const char *name
= 0;
11599 if (TYPE_NAME (type
) != 0)
11603 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
11604 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type
)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE
)
11605 t
= TYPE_NAME (type
);
11607 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
11608 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
11610 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type
)) == TYPE_DECL
11611 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type
)))
11613 /* We want to be extra verbose. Don't call dwarf_name if
11614 DECL_NAME isn't set. The default hook for decl_printable_name
11615 doesn't like that, and in this context it's correct to return
11616 0, instead of "<anonymous>" or the like. */
11617 if (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type
)))
11618 name
= lang_hooks
.dwarf_name (TYPE_NAME (type
), 2);
11621 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
11622 if (!name
&& t
!= 0)
11623 name
= IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t
);
11626 return (name
== 0 || *name
== '\0') ? 0 : name
;
11629 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
11630 for bit field types. */
11633 member_declared_type (const_tree member
)
11635 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member
)
11636 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member
) : TREE_TYPE (member
));
11639 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
11640 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
11643 static const char *
11644 decl_start_label (tree decl
)
11647 const char *fnname
;
11649 x
= DECL_RTL (decl
);
11650 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x
));
11653 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x
) == SYMBOL_REF
);
11655 fnname
= XSTR (x
, 0);
11660 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
11661 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
11662 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
11665 gen_array_type_die (tree type
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
11667 dw_die_ref scope_die
= scope_die_for (type
, context_die
);
11668 dw_die_ref array_die
;
11671 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types unless
11672 the inner array type comes before the outer array type. Thus we must
11673 call gen_type_die before we call new_die. See below also. */
11674 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11675 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type
), context_die
);
11678 array_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_array_type
, scope_die
, type
);
11679 add_name_attribute (array_die
, type_tag (type
));
11680 equate_type_number_to_die (type
, array_die
);
11682 if (TREE_CODE (type
) == VECTOR_TYPE
)
11684 /* The frontend feeds us a representation for the vector as a struct
11685 containing an array. Pull out the array type. */
11686 type
= TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type
)));
11687 add_AT_flag (array_die
, DW_AT_GNU_vector
, 1);
11690 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
11692 && TREE_CODE (type
) == ARRAY_TYPE
11693 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type
)) == ARRAY_TYPE
)
11694 add_AT_unsigned (array_die
, DW_AT_ordering
, DW_ORD_col_major
);
11697 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
11698 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
11699 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
11700 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
11701 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
11702 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
11703 for multidimensional arrays. */
11704 add_AT_unsigned (array_die
, DW_AT_ordering
, DW_ORD_row_major
);
11707 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11708 /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
11709 AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs. */
11710 if (! TYPE_DOMAIN (type
))
11711 add_AT_flag (array_die
, DW_AT_declaration
, 1);
11714 add_subscript_info (array_die
, type
);
11716 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type. */
11717 element_type
= TREE_TYPE (type
);
11719 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
11720 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
11721 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
11722 add_subscript_info. */
11723 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11724 while (TREE_CODE (element_type
) == ARRAY_TYPE
)
11725 element_type
= TREE_TYPE (element_type
);
11727 gen_type_die (element_type
, context_die
);
11730 add_type_attribute (array_die
, element_type
, 0, 0, context_die
);
11732 if (get_AT (array_die
, DW_AT_name
))
11733 add_pubtype (type
, array_die
);
11736 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11737 descr_info_loc (tree val
, tree base_decl
)
11739 HOST_WIDE_INT size
;
11740 dw_loc_descr_ref loc
, loc2
;
11741 enum dwarf_location_atom op
;
11743 if (val
== base_decl
)
11744 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address
, 0, 0);
11746 switch (TREE_CODE (val
))
11750 return descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val
, 0), base_decl
);
11752 if (host_integerp (val
, 0))
11753 return int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (val
, 0));
11756 size
= int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (val
));
11759 loc
= descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val
, 0), base_decl
);
11762 if (size
== DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
)
11763 add_loc_descr (&loc
, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref
, 0, 0));
11765 add_loc_descr (&loc
, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size
, size
, 0));
11767 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
:
11769 if (host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (val
, 1), 1)
11770 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
) tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (val
, 1), 1)
11773 loc
= descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val
, 0), base_decl
);
11776 add_loc_descr (&loc
,
11777 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst
,
11778 tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (val
, 1),
11785 loc
= descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val
, 0), base_decl
);
11788 loc2
= descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val
, 1), base_decl
);
11791 add_loc_descr (&loc
, loc2
);
11792 add_loc_descr (&loc2
, new_loc_descr (op
, 0, 0));
11814 add_descr_info_field (dw_die_ref die
, enum dwarf_attribute attr
,
11815 tree val
, tree base_decl
)
11817 dw_loc_descr_ref loc
;
11819 if (host_integerp (val
, 0))
11821 add_AT_unsigned (die
, attr
, tree_low_cst (val
, 0));
11825 loc
= descr_info_loc (val
, base_decl
);
11829 add_AT_loc (die
, attr
, loc
);
11832 /* This routine generates DIE for array with hidden descriptor, details
11833 are filled into *info by a langhook. */
11836 gen_descr_array_type_die (tree type
, struct array_descr_info
*info
,
11837 dw_die_ref context_die
)
11839 dw_die_ref scope_die
= scope_die_for (type
, context_die
);
11840 dw_die_ref array_die
;
11843 array_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_array_type
, scope_die
, type
);
11844 add_name_attribute (array_die
, type_tag (type
));
11845 equate_type_number_to_die (type
, array_die
);
11847 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
11849 && info
->ndimensions
>= 2)
11850 add_AT_unsigned (array_die
, DW_AT_ordering
, DW_ORD_col_major
);
11852 if (info
->data_location
)
11853 add_descr_info_field (array_die
, DW_AT_data_location
, info
->data_location
,
11855 if (info
->associated
)
11856 add_descr_info_field (array_die
, DW_AT_associated
, info
->associated
,
11858 if (info
->allocated
)
11859 add_descr_info_field (array_die
, DW_AT_allocated
, info
->allocated
,
11862 for (dim
= 0; dim
< info
->ndimensions
; dim
++)
11864 dw_die_ref subrange_die
11865 = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type
, array_die
, NULL
);
11867 if (info
->dimen
[dim
].lower_bound
)
11869 /* If it is the default value, omit it. */
11870 if ((is_c_family () || is_java ())
11871 && integer_zerop (info
->dimen
[dim
].lower_bound
))
11873 else if (is_fortran ()
11874 && integer_onep (info
->dimen
[dim
].lower_bound
))
11877 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die
, DW_AT_lower_bound
,
11878 info
->dimen
[dim
].lower_bound
,
11881 if (info
->dimen
[dim
].upper_bound
)
11882 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die
, DW_AT_upper_bound
,
11883 info
->dimen
[dim
].upper_bound
,
11885 if (info
->dimen
[dim
].stride
)
11886 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die
, DW_AT_byte_stride
,
11887 info
->dimen
[dim
].stride
,
11891 gen_type_die (info
->element_type
, context_die
);
11892 add_type_attribute (array_die
, info
->element_type
, 0, 0, context_die
);
11894 if (get_AT (array_die
, DW_AT_name
))
11895 add_pubtype (type
, array_die
);
11900 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
11902 tree origin
= decl_ultimate_origin (decl
);
11903 dw_die_ref decl_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point
, context_die
, decl
);
11905 if (origin
!= NULL
)
11906 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die
, origin
);
11909 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die
, decl
);
11910 add_type_attribute (decl_die
, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl
)),
11911 0, 0, context_die
);
11914 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl
))
11915 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl
, decl_die
);
11917 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die
, DW_AT_low_pc
, decl_start_label (decl
));
11921 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
11922 emit full debugging info for them. */
11925 retry_incomplete_types (void)
11929 for (i
= VEC_length (tree
, incomplete_types
) - 1; i
>= 0; i
--)
11930 gen_type_die (VEC_index (tree
, incomplete_types
, i
), comp_unit_die
);
11933 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of an enumeration type. */
11936 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree type
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
11938 dw_die_ref type_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type
, context_die
, type
);
11940 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11941 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11942 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die
, type
);
11945 /* Determine what tag to use for a record type. */
11947 static enum dwarf_tag
11948 record_type_tag (tree type
)
11950 if (! lang_hooks
.types
.classify_record
)
11951 return DW_TAG_structure_type
;
11953 switch (lang_hooks
.types
.classify_record (type
))
11955 case RECORD_IS_STRUCT
:
11956 return DW_TAG_structure_type
;
11958 case RECORD_IS_CLASS
:
11959 return DW_TAG_class_type
;
11961 case RECORD_IS_INTERFACE
:
11962 return DW_TAG_interface_type
;
11965 gcc_unreachable ();
11969 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a structure type. */
11972 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree type
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
11974 dw_die_ref type_die
= new_die (record_type_tag (type
), context_die
, type
);
11976 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11977 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11978 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die
, type
);
11981 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a union type. */
11984 gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree type
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
11986 dw_die_ref type_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_union_type
, context_die
, type
);
11988 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11989 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11990 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die
, type
);
11993 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
11994 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
11995 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
11999 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
12001 dw_die_ref type_die
= lookup_type_die (type
);
12003 if (type_die
== NULL
)
12005 type_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type
,
12006 scope_die_for (type
, context_die
), type
);
12007 equate_type_number_to_die (type
, type_die
);
12008 add_name_attribute (type_die
, type_tag (type
));
12010 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type
))
12013 remove_AT (type_die
, DW_AT_declaration
);
12015 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
12016 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
12017 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
12018 if (TYPE_SIZE (type
))
12022 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type
) = 1;
12023 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die
, type
);
12024 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type
) != NULL_TREE
)
12025 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die
, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type
));
12027 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
12028 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
12029 if (type_die
->die_parent
== NULL
)
12030 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type
, context_die
), type_die
);
12032 for (link
= TYPE_VALUES (type
);
12033 link
!= NULL
; link
= TREE_CHAIN (link
))
12035 dw_die_ref enum_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator
, type_die
, link
);
12036 tree value
= TREE_VALUE (link
);
12038 add_name_attribute (enum_die
,
12039 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link
)));
12041 if (host_integerp (value
, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value
))))
12042 /* DWARF2 does not provide a way of indicating whether or
12043 not enumeration constants are signed or unsigned. GDB
12044 always assumes the values are signed, so we output all
12045 values as if they were signed. That means that
12046 enumeration constants with very large unsigned values
12047 will appear to have negative values in the debugger. */
12048 add_AT_int (enum_die
, DW_AT_const_value
,
12049 tree_low_cst (value
, tree_int_cst_sgn (value
) > 0));
12053 add_AT_flag (type_die
, DW_AT_declaration
, 1);
12055 if (get_AT (type_die
, DW_AT_name
))
12056 add_pubtype (type
, type_die
);
12061 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
12062 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
12065 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
12066 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
12067 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
12068 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
12069 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
12070 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
12071 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
12072 argument type of some subprogram type. */
12075 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
12077 dw_die_ref parm_die
12078 = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter
, context_die
, node
);
12081 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node
)))
12083 case tcc_declaration
:
12084 origin
= decl_ultimate_origin (node
);
12085 if (origin
!= NULL
)
12086 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die
, origin
);
12089 tree type
= TREE_TYPE (node
);
12090 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die
, node
);
12091 if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (node
))
12092 type
= TREE_TYPE (type
);
12093 add_type_attribute (parm_die
, type
,
12094 TREE_READONLY (node
),
12095 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node
),
12097 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node
))
12098 add_AT_flag (parm_die
, DW_AT_artificial
, 1);
12101 equate_decl_number_to_die (node
, parm_die
);
12102 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node
))
12103 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die
, node
, DW_AT_location
);
12108 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
12109 add_type_attribute (parm_die
, node
, 0, 0, context_die
);
12113 gcc_unreachable ();
12119 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
12120 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
12123 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
12125 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters
, context_die
, decl_or_type
);
12128 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
12129 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
12130 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
12131 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
12134 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
12137 tree formal_type
= NULL
;
12138 tree first_parm_type
;
12141 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type
) == FUNCTION_DECL
)
12143 arg
= DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type
);
12144 function_or_method_type
= TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type
);
12149 first_parm_type
= TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type
);
12151 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
12152 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
12153 for (link
= first_parm_type
; link
; )
12155 dw_die_ref parm_die
;
12157 formal_type
= TREE_VALUE (link
);
12158 if (formal_type
== void_type_node
)
12161 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
12162 parm_die
= gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type
, context_die
);
12163 if ((TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type
) == METHOD_TYPE
12164 && link
== first_parm_type
)
12165 || (arg
&& DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg
)))
12166 add_AT_flag (parm_die
, DW_AT_artificial
, 1);
12168 link
= TREE_CHAIN (link
);
12170 arg
= TREE_CHAIN (arg
);
12173 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
12174 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
12175 if (formal_type
!= void_type_node
)
12176 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type
, context_die
);
12178 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
12179 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
12180 for (link
= TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type
);
12181 link
&& TREE_VALUE (link
);
12182 link
= TREE_CHAIN (link
))
12183 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link
), context_die
);
12186 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
12187 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
12188 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
12189 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
12190 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
12193 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type
, tree member
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
12195 gen_type_die (type
, context_die
);
12197 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
12198 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
12199 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type
))
12200 && ! lookup_decl_die (member
))
12202 dw_die_ref type_die
;
12203 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member
));
12205 push_decl_scope (type
);
12206 type_die
= lookup_type_die (type
);
12207 if (TREE_CODE (member
) == FUNCTION_DECL
)
12208 gen_subprogram_die (member
, type_die
);
12209 else if (TREE_CODE (member
) == FIELD_DECL
)
12211 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
12212 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
12213 if (DECL_NAME (member
) != NULL_TREE
12214 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member
)) == UNION_TYPE
12215 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member
)) == RECORD_TYPE
)
12217 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member
), type_die
);
12218 gen_field_die (member
, type_die
);
12222 gen_variable_die (member
, type_die
);
12228 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
12229 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
12232 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl
)
12234 dw_die_ref old_die
;
12237 int was_abstract
= DECL_ABSTRACT (decl
);
12239 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
12240 decl
= DECL_ORIGIN (decl
);
12242 old_die
= lookup_decl_die (decl
);
12243 if (old_die
&& get_AT (old_die
, DW_AT_inline
))
12244 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
12247 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
12248 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT. */
12249 if (debug_info_level
> DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
)
12251 context
= decl_class_context (decl
);
12253 gen_type_die_for_member
12254 (context
, decl
, decl_function_context (decl
) ? NULL
: comp_unit_die
);
12257 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
12258 save_fn
= current_function_decl
;
12259 current_function_decl
= decl
;
12260 push_cfun (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl
));
12262 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl
, 1);
12263 dwarf2out_decl (decl
);
12264 if (! was_abstract
)
12265 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl
, 0);
12267 current_function_decl
= save_fn
;
12271 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
12272 htab_traverse_resize().
12274 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
12275 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. */
12277 premark_used_types_helper (void **slot
, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
12283 die
= lookup_type_die (type
);
12285 die
->die_perennial_p
= 1;
12289 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial. */
12291 premark_used_types (void)
12293 if (cfun
&& cfun
->used_types_hash
)
12294 htab_traverse (cfun
->used_types_hash
, premark_used_types_helper
, NULL
);
12297 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
12301 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
12303 char label_id
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
12304 tree origin
= decl_ultimate_origin (decl
);
12305 dw_die_ref subr_die
;
12308 dw_die_ref old_die
= lookup_decl_die (decl
);
12309 int declaration
= (current_function_decl
!= decl
12310 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die
));
12312 premark_used_types ();
12314 /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
12315 started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
12316 its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
12317 from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
12318 we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
12320 /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
12321 if (origin
&& declaration
&& class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die
))
12324 gcc_assert (!old_die
);
12327 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
12328 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
12329 if (!declaration
&& !origin
&& !old_die
12330 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl
) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl
))
12331 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die
)
12332 && debug_info_level
> DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
)
12333 old_die
= force_decl_die (decl
);
12335 if (origin
!= NULL
)
12337 gcc_assert (!declaration
|| local_scope_p (context_die
));
12339 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
12340 inline function. */
12341 if (old_die
&& old_die
->die_parent
== NULL
)
12342 add_child_die (context_die
, old_die
);
12344 subr_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram
, context_die
, decl
);
12345 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die
, origin
);
12349 expanded_location s
= expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl
));
12350 struct dwarf_file_data
* file_index
= lookup_filename (s
.file
);
12352 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die
, DW_AT_declaration
)
12353 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
12354 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
12355 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
12356 && !get_AT (old_die
, DW_AT_inline
))
12358 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
12359 something we have already output. */
12363 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
12364 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
12365 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
12366 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
12367 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
12368 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
12369 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
12370 if ((old_die
->die_parent
== comp_unit_die
|| context_die
== NULL
)
12371 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl
)
12372 || (get_AT_file (old_die
, DW_AT_decl_file
) == file_index
12373 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die
, DW_AT_decl_line
)
12374 == (unsigned) s
.line
))))
12376 subr_die
= old_die
;
12378 /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the formal parameters.
12379 Do not remove all children, because it is possible that this
12380 declaration die was forced using force_decl_die(). In such
12381 cases die that forced declaration die (e.g. TAG_imported_module)
12382 is one of the children that we do not want to remove. */
12383 remove_AT (subr_die
, DW_AT_declaration
);
12384 remove_child_TAG (subr_die
, DW_TAG_formal_parameter
);
12388 subr_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram
, context_die
, decl
);
12389 add_AT_specification (subr_die
, old_die
);
12390 if (get_AT_file (old_die
, DW_AT_decl_file
) != file_index
)
12391 add_AT_file (subr_die
, DW_AT_decl_file
, file_index
);
12392 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die
, DW_AT_decl_line
) != (unsigned) s
.line
)
12393 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die
, DW_AT_decl_line
, s
.line
);
12398 subr_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram
, context_die
, decl
);
12400 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl
))
12401 add_AT_flag (subr_die
, DW_AT_external
, 1);
12403 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die
, decl
);
12404 if (debug_info_level
> DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
)
12406 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die
, TREE_TYPE (decl
));
12407 add_type_attribute (subr_die
, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl
)),
12408 0, 0, context_die
);
12411 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die
, decl
);
12412 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl
))
12413 add_AT_flag (subr_die
, DW_AT_artificial
, 1);
12415 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl
))
12416 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die
, DW_AT_accessibility
, DW_ACCESS_protected
);
12417 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl
))
12418 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die
, DW_AT_accessibility
, DW_ACCESS_private
);
12423 if (!old_die
|| !get_AT (old_die
, DW_AT_inline
))
12425 add_AT_flag (subr_die
, DW_AT_declaration
, 1);
12427 /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
12428 the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
12429 the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
12430 handled above. The two may come from the same source text.
12432 Note that force_decl_die() forces function declaration die. It is
12433 later reused to represent definition. */
12434 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl
, subr_die
);
12437 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl
))
12439 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl
))
12441 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl
))
12442 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die
, DW_AT_inline
, DW_INL_declared_inlined
);
12444 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die
, DW_AT_inline
, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined
);
12448 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl
))
12449 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die
, DW_AT_inline
, DW_INL_inlined
);
12451 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die
, DW_AT_inline
, DW_INL_not_inlined
);
12454 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl
)
12455 && lookup_attribute ("artificial", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl
)))
12456 add_AT_flag (subr_die
, DW_AT_artificial
, 1);
12458 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl
, subr_die
);
12460 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl
))
12462 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset
;
12464 if (!old_die
|| !get_AT (old_die
, DW_AT_inline
))
12465 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl
, subr_die
);
12467 if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition
)
12469 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id
, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
,
12470 current_function_funcdef_no
);
12471 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die
, DW_AT_low_pc
, label_id
);
12472 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id
, FUNC_END_LABEL
,
12473 current_function_funcdef_no
);
12474 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die
, DW_AT_high_pc
, label_id
);
12476 add_pubname (decl
, subr_die
);
12477 add_arange (decl
, subr_die
);
12480 { /* Do nothing for now; maybe need to duplicate die, one for
12481 hot section and ond for cold section, then use the hot/cold
12482 section begin/end labels to generate the aranges... */
12484 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, hot_section_label);
12485 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, hot_section_end_label);
12486 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_lo_user, unlikely_section_label);
12487 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_hi_user, cold_section_end_label);
12489 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
12490 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
12491 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
12495 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12496 /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine. */
12497 add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die
, DW_AT_MIPS_fde
, current_funcdef_fde
);
12500 cfa_fb_offset
= CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl
);
12502 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
12503 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
12504 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
12505 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
12506 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
12507 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
12508 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
12510 /* ??? Use some command-line or configury switch to enable the use
12511 of dwarf3 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. At present there are no dwarf
12512 consumers that understand it; fall back to "pure" dwarf2 and
12513 convert the CFA data into a location list. */
12515 dw_loc_list_ref list
= convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset
);
12516 if (list
->dw_loc_next
)
12517 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die
, DW_AT_frame_base
, list
);
12519 add_AT_loc (subr_die
, DW_AT_frame_base
, list
->expr
);
12522 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
12523 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
12524 will reference in the rtl; the later is what we've told the
12525 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
12526 by this displacement. */
12527 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset
);
12529 if (cfun
->static_chain_decl
)
12530 add_AT_location_description (subr_die
, DW_AT_static_link
,
12531 loc_descriptor_from_tree (cfun
->static_chain_decl
));
12534 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
12535 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
12536 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
12537 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
12538 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
12539 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
12540 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
12541 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
12542 an ellipsis at the end. */
12544 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
12545 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
12546 its formal parameters. */
12547 if (debug_info_level
<= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
)
12549 else if (declaration
)
12550 gen_formal_types_die (decl
, subr_die
);
12553 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
12554 tree arg_decls
= DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl
);
12557 /* When generating DIEs, generate the unspecified_parameters DIE
12558 instead if we come across the arg "__builtin_va_alist" */
12559 for (parm
= arg_decls
; parm
; parm
= TREE_CHAIN (parm
))
12560 if (TREE_CODE (parm
) == PARM_DECL
)
12562 if (DECL_NAME (parm
)
12563 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm
)),
12564 "__builtin_va_alist"))
12565 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (parm
, subr_die
);
12567 gen_decl_die (parm
, subr_die
);
12570 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
12571 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
12572 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
12573 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
12574 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
12575 parameters at all. */
12576 fn_arg_types
= TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl
));
12577 if (fn_arg_types
!= NULL
)
12579 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
12580 if (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (fn_arg_types
)) != void_type_node
)
12581 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl
, subr_die
);
12583 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl
) == NULL_TREE
)
12584 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl
, subr_die
);
12587 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
12588 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
12589 outer_scope
= DECL_INITIAL (decl
);
12591 /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
12592 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
12593 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
12594 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
12595 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
12596 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
12597 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
12599 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
12600 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
12601 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
12602 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
12603 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
12604 constructor function. */
12605 if (! declaration
&& TREE_CODE (outer_scope
) != ERROR_MARK
)
12607 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
12608 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl
)))
12609 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl
), subr_die
);
12611 current_function_has_inlines
= 0;
12612 decls_for_scope (outer_scope
, subr_die
, 0);
12614 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
12615 if (current_function_has_inlines
)
12617 add_AT_flag (subr_die
, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines
, 1);
12618 if (! comp_unit_has_inlines
)
12620 add_AT_flag (comp_unit_die
, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines
, 1);
12621 comp_unit_has_inlines
= 1;
12626 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
12627 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die
, decl
);
12631 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object. */
12634 gen_variable_die (tree decl
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
12636 tree origin
= decl_ultimate_origin (decl
);
12637 dw_die_ref var_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_variable
, context_die
, decl
);
12639 dw_die_ref old_die
= lookup_decl_die (decl
);
12640 int declaration
= (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl
)
12641 /* If DECL is COMDAT and has not actually been
12642 emitted, we cannot take its address; there
12643 might end up being no definition anywhere in
12644 the program. For example, consider the C++
12648 struct S { static const int i = 7; };
12653 int f() { return S<int>::i; }
12655 Here, S<int>::i is not DECL_EXTERNAL, but no
12656 definition is required, so the compiler will
12657 not emit a definition. */
12658 || (TREE_CODE (decl
) == VAR_DECL
12659 && DECL_COMDAT (decl
) && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl
))
12660 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die
));
12662 if (origin
!= NULL
)
12663 add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die
, origin
);
12665 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
12666 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
12668 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
12669 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
12672 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.
12674 ??? The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
12675 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid considering
12676 one to be a specification, so we must test that this DIE is not a
12678 else if (old_die
&& TREE_STATIC (decl
) && ! declaration
12679 && get_AT_flag (old_die
, DW_AT_declaration
) == 1)
12681 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
12682 add_AT_specification (var_die
, old_die
);
12683 if (DECL_NAME (decl
))
12685 expanded_location s
= expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl
));
12686 struct dwarf_file_data
* file_index
= lookup_filename (s
.file
);
12688 if (get_AT_file (old_die
, DW_AT_decl_file
) != file_index
)
12689 add_AT_file (var_die
, DW_AT_decl_file
, file_index
);
12691 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die
, DW_AT_decl_line
) != (unsigned) s
.line
)
12692 add_AT_unsigned (var_die
, DW_AT_decl_line
, s
.line
);
12697 tree type
= TREE_TYPE (decl
);
12698 if ((TREE_CODE (decl
) == PARM_DECL
12699 || TREE_CODE (decl
) == RESULT_DECL
)
12700 && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl
))
12701 type
= TREE_TYPE (type
);
12703 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die
, decl
);
12704 add_type_attribute (var_die
, type
, TREE_READONLY (decl
),
12705 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl
), context_die
);
12707 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl
))
12708 add_AT_flag (var_die
, DW_AT_external
, 1);
12710 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl
))
12711 add_AT_flag (var_die
, DW_AT_artificial
, 1);
12713 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl
))
12714 add_AT_unsigned (var_die
, DW_AT_accessibility
, DW_ACCESS_protected
);
12715 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl
))
12716 add_AT_unsigned (var_die
, DW_AT_accessibility
, DW_ACCESS_private
);
12720 add_AT_flag (var_die
, DW_AT_declaration
, 1);
12722 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl
) || declaration
)
12723 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl
, var_die
);
12725 if (! declaration
&& ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl
))
12727 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die
, decl
, DW_AT_location
);
12728 add_pubname (decl
, var_die
);
12731 tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die
, decl
);
12734 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
12737 gen_label_die (tree decl
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
12739 tree origin
= decl_ultimate_origin (decl
);
12740 dw_die_ref lbl_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_label
, context_die
, decl
);
12742 char label
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
12744 if (origin
!= NULL
)
12745 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die
, origin
);
12747 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die
, decl
);
12749 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl
))
12750 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl
, lbl_die
);
12753 insn
= DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl
);
12755 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
12756 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
12757 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
12761 && NOTE_KIND (insn
) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL
))))
12763 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
12764 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
12765 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
12766 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
12767 it if it ever does happen. */
12768 gcc_assert (!INSN_DELETED_P (insn
));
12770 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label
, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn
));
12771 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die
, DW_AT_low_pc
, label
);
12776 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
12777 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
12778 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
12781 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt
, dw_die_ref die
)
12783 expanded_location s
= expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt
));
12785 add_AT_file (die
, DW_AT_call_file
, lookup_filename (s
.file
));
12786 add_AT_unsigned (die
, DW_AT_call_line
, s
.line
);
12790 /* If STMT's abstract origin is a function declaration and STMT's
12791 first subblock's abstract origin is the function's outermost block,
12792 then we're looking at the main entry point. */
12794 is_inlined_entry_point (const_tree stmt
)
12798 if (!stmt
|| TREE_CODE (stmt
) != BLOCK
)
12801 decl
= block_ultimate_origin (stmt
);
12803 if (!decl
|| TREE_CODE (decl
) != FUNCTION_DECL
)
12806 block
= BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt
);
12810 if (TREE_CODE (block
) != BLOCK
)
12813 block
= block_ultimate_origin (block
);
12816 return block
== DECL_INITIAL (decl
);
12819 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
12820 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
12823 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt
, dw_die_ref die
)
12825 char label
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
12827 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt
))
12831 if (is_inlined_entry_point (stmt
))
12833 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label
, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
,
12834 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt
));
12835 add_AT_lbl_id (die
, DW_AT_entry_pc
, label
);
12838 add_AT_range_list (die
, DW_AT_ranges
, add_ranges (stmt
));
12840 chain
= BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt
);
12843 add_ranges (chain
);
12844 chain
= BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain
);
12851 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label
, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
,
12852 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt
));
12853 add_AT_lbl_id (die
, DW_AT_low_pc
, label
);
12854 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label
, BLOCK_END_LABEL
,
12855 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt
));
12856 add_AT_lbl_id (die
, DW_AT_high_pc
, label
);
12860 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
12863 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt
, dw_die_ref context_die
, int depth
)
12865 dw_die_ref stmt_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block
, context_die
, stmt
);
12867 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt
))
12868 add_high_low_attributes (stmt
, stmt_die
);
12870 decls_for_scope (stmt
, stmt_die
, depth
);
12873 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
12876 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt
, dw_die_ref context_die
, int depth
)
12878 tree decl
= block_ultimate_origin (stmt
);
12880 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. We
12881 must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
12882 emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
12883 a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing. */
12884 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl
);
12886 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt
))
12888 dw_die_ref subr_die
12889 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
, context_die
, stmt
);
12891 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die
, decl
);
12892 add_high_low_attributes (stmt
, subr_die
);
12893 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt
, subr_die
);
12895 decls_for_scope (stmt
, subr_die
, depth
);
12896 current_function_has_inlines
= 1;
12899 /* We may get here if we're the outer block of function A that was
12900 inlined into function B that was inlined into function C. When
12901 generating debugging info for C, dwarf2out_abstract_function(B)
12902 would mark all inlined blocks as abstract, including this one.
12903 So, we wouldn't (and shouldn't) expect labels to be generated
12904 for this one. Instead, just emit debugging info for
12905 declarations within the block. This is particularly important
12906 in the case of initializers of arguments passed from B to us:
12907 if they're statement expressions containing declarations, we
12908 wouldn't generate dies for their abstract variables, and then,
12909 when generating dies for the real variables, we'd die (pun
12911 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt
, context_die
, depth
);
12914 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
12917 gen_field_die (tree decl
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
12919 dw_die_ref decl_die
;
12921 if (TREE_TYPE (decl
) == error_mark_node
)
12924 decl_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_member
, context_die
, decl
);
12925 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die
, decl
);
12926 add_type_attribute (decl_die
, member_declared_type (decl
),
12927 TREE_READONLY (decl
), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl
),
12930 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl
))
12932 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die
, decl
);
12933 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die
, decl
);
12934 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die
, decl
);
12937 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl
)) != UNION_TYPE
)
12938 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die
, decl
);
12940 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl
))
12941 add_AT_flag (decl_die
, DW_AT_artificial
, 1);
12943 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl
))
12944 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die
, DW_AT_accessibility
, DW_ACCESS_protected
);
12945 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl
))
12946 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die
, DW_AT_accessibility
, DW_ACCESS_private
);
12948 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
12949 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl
, decl_die
);
12953 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
12954 Use modified_type_die instead.
12955 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
12956 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
12959 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
12962 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type
, scope_die_for (type
, context_die
), type
);
12964 equate_type_number_to_die (type
, ptr_die
);
12965 add_type_attribute (ptr_die
, TREE_TYPE (type
), 0, 0, context_die
);
12966 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die
, DW_AT_byte_size
, PTR_SIZE
);
12969 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
12970 Use modified_type_die instead.
12971 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
12972 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
12975 gen_reference_type_die (tree type
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
12978 = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type
, scope_die_for (type
, context_die
), type
);
12980 equate_type_number_to_die (type
, ref_die
);
12981 add_type_attribute (ref_die
, TREE_TYPE (type
), 0, 0, context_die
);
12982 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die
, DW_AT_byte_size
, PTR_SIZE
);
12986 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
12989 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
12992 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type
,
12993 scope_die_for (type
, context_die
), type
);
12995 equate_type_number_to_die (type
, ptr_die
);
12996 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die
, DW_AT_containing_type
,
12997 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type
)));
12998 add_type_attribute (ptr_die
, TREE_TYPE (type
), 0, 0, context_die
);
13001 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
13004 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename
)
13007 char producer
[250];
13008 const char *language_string
= lang_hooks
.name
;
13011 die
= new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit
, NULL
, NULL
);
13015 add_name_attribute (die
, filename
);
13016 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
13017 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename
) && filename
[0] != '<')
13018 add_comp_dir_attribute (die
);
13021 sprintf (producer
, "%s %s", language_string
, version_string
);
13023 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
13024 /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
13025 string. The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
13026 not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
13027 that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
13028 To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
13029 information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string. */
13030 if (debug_info_level
> DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
)
13031 strcat (producer
, " -g");
13034 add_AT_string (die
, DW_AT_producer
, producer
);
13036 if (strcmp (language_string
, "GNU C++") == 0)
13037 language
= DW_LANG_C_plus_plus
;
13038 else if (strcmp (language_string
, "GNU Ada") == 0)
13039 language
= DW_LANG_Ada95
;
13040 else if (strcmp (language_string
, "GNU F77") == 0)
13041 language
= DW_LANG_Fortran77
;
13042 else if (strcmp (language_string
, "GNU F95") == 0)
13043 language
= DW_LANG_Fortran95
;
13044 else if (strcmp (language_string
, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
13045 language
= DW_LANG_Pascal83
;
13046 else if (strcmp (language_string
, "GNU Java") == 0)
13047 language
= DW_LANG_Java
;
13048 else if (strcmp (language_string
, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
13049 language
= DW_LANG_ObjC
;
13050 else if (strcmp (language_string
, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
13051 language
= DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus
;
13053 language
= DW_LANG_C89
;
13055 add_AT_unsigned (die
, DW_AT_language
, language
);
13059 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
13062 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo
, tree access
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
13064 dw_die_ref die
= new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance
, context_die
, binfo
);
13066 add_type_attribute (die
, BINFO_TYPE (binfo
), 0, 0, context_die
);
13067 add_data_member_location_attribute (die
, binfo
);
13069 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo
))
13070 add_AT_unsigned (die
, DW_AT_virtuality
, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual
);
13072 if (access
== access_public_node
)
13073 add_AT_unsigned (die
, DW_AT_accessibility
, DW_ACCESS_public
);
13074 else if (access
== access_protected_node
)
13075 add_AT_unsigned (die
, DW_AT_accessibility
, DW_ACCESS_protected
);
13078 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
13081 gen_member_die (tree type
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
13084 tree binfo
= TYPE_BINFO (type
);
13087 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
13088 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
13089 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
13090 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
13091 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
13092 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
13093 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
13094 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
13095 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
13096 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
13097 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
13099 /* First output info about the base classes. */
13102 VEC(tree
,gc
) *accesses
= BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo
);
13106 for (i
= 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo
, i
, base
); i
++)
13107 gen_inheritance_die (base
,
13108 (accesses
? VEC_index (tree
, accesses
, i
)
13109 : access_public_node
), context_die
);
13112 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
13113 for (member
= TYPE_FIELDS (type
); member
; member
= TREE_CHAIN (member
))
13115 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
13116 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
13117 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
13118 do put them in the right order. */
13120 child
= lookup_decl_die (member
);
13122 splice_child_die (context_die
, child
);
13124 gen_decl_die (member
, context_die
);
13127 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
13128 for (member
= TYPE_METHODS (type
); member
; member
= TREE_CHAIN (member
))
13130 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
13131 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member
))
13134 child
= lookup_decl_die (member
);
13136 splice_child_die (context_die
, child
);
13138 gen_decl_die (member
, context_die
);
13142 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
13143 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
13144 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
13147 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type
, dw_die_ref context_die
,
13148 enum debug_info_usage usage
)
13150 dw_die_ref type_die
= lookup_type_die (type
);
13151 dw_die_ref scope_die
= 0;
13153 int complete
= (TYPE_SIZE (type
)
13154 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type
)
13155 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type
))));
13156 int ns_decl
= (context_die
&& context_die
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_namespace
);
13157 complete
= complete
&& should_emit_struct_debug (type
, usage
);
13159 if (type_die
&& ! complete
)
13162 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type
) != NULL_TREE
13163 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type
))
13164 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type
)) == NAMESPACE_DECL
))
13167 scope_die
= scope_die_for (type
, context_die
);
13169 if (! type_die
|| (nested
&& scope_die
== comp_unit_die
))
13170 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
13172 dw_die_ref old_die
= type_die
;
13174 type_die
= new_die (TREE_CODE (type
) == RECORD_TYPE
13175 ? record_type_tag (type
) : DW_TAG_union_type
,
13177 equate_type_number_to_die (type
, type_die
);
13179 add_AT_specification (type_die
, old_die
);
13181 add_name_attribute (type_die
, type_tag (type
));
13184 remove_AT (type_die
, DW_AT_declaration
);
13186 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
13187 then give a list of members. */
13188 if (complete
&& !ns_decl
)
13190 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
13191 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
13192 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type
) = 1;
13193 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die
, type
);
13194 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type
) != NULL_TREE
)
13195 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die
, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type
));
13197 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
13198 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
13199 if (type_die
->die_parent
== NULL
)
13200 add_child_die (scope_die
, type_die
);
13202 push_decl_scope (type
);
13203 gen_member_die (type
, type_die
);
13206 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
13207 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type
))
13209 tree vtype
= DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type
));
13211 gen_type_die (vtype
, context_die
);
13212 add_AT_die_ref (type_die
, DW_AT_containing_type
,
13213 lookup_type_die (vtype
));
13218 add_AT_flag (type_die
, DW_AT_declaration
, 1);
13220 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
13221 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type
)
13222 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type
)))
13223 VEC_safe_push (tree
, gc
, incomplete_types
, type
);
13226 if (get_AT (type_die
, DW_AT_name
))
13227 add_pubtype (type
, type_die
);
13230 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
13233 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
13235 tree return_type
= TREE_TYPE (type
);
13236 dw_die_ref subr_die
13237 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type
,
13238 scope_die_for (type
, context_die
), type
);
13240 equate_type_number_to_die (type
, subr_die
);
13241 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die
, type
);
13242 add_type_attribute (subr_die
, return_type
, 0, 0, context_die
);
13243 gen_formal_types_die (type
, subr_die
);
13245 if (get_AT (subr_die
, DW_AT_name
))
13246 add_pubtype (type
, subr_die
);
13249 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
13252 gen_typedef_die (tree decl
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
13254 dw_die_ref type_die
;
13257 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl
))
13260 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl
) = 1;
13261 type_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_typedef
, context_die
, decl
);
13262 origin
= decl_ultimate_origin (decl
);
13263 if (origin
!= NULL
)
13264 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die
, origin
);
13269 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die
, decl
);
13270 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl
))
13272 type
= DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl
);
13274 gcc_assert (type
!= TREE_TYPE (decl
));
13275 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl
), type_die
);
13278 type
= TREE_TYPE (decl
);
13280 add_type_attribute (type_die
, type
, TREE_READONLY (decl
),
13281 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl
), context_die
);
13284 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl
))
13285 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl
, type_die
);
13287 if (get_AT (type_die
, DW_AT_name
))
13288 add_pubtype (decl
, type_die
);
13291 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
13294 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type
, dw_die_ref context_die
,
13295 enum debug_info_usage usage
)
13298 struct array_descr_info info
;
13300 if (type
== NULL_TREE
|| type
== error_mark_node
)
13303 if (TYPE_NAME (type
) && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type
)) == TYPE_DECL
13304 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type
)))
13306 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type
))
13309 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
13310 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type
)) != type
);
13312 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type
) = 1;
13313 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type
), context_die
);
13317 /* If this is an array type with hidden descriptor, handle it first. */
13318 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type
)
13319 && lang_hooks
.types
.get_array_descr_info
13320 && lang_hooks
.types
.get_array_descr_info (type
, &info
))
13322 gen_descr_array_type_die (type
, &info
, context_die
);
13323 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type
) = 1;
13327 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
13328 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
13329 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
13330 now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
13331 cloned type itself). */
13332 if (TREE_CODE (type
) != VECTOR_TYPE
)
13333 type
= type_main_variant (type
);
13335 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type
))
13338 switch (TREE_CODE (type
))
13344 case REFERENCE_TYPE
:
13345 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
13346 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
13347 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
13348 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
13350 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type
) = 1;
13352 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
13353 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
13354 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type
), context_die
,
13355 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE
);
13359 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
13360 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
13361 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type
), context_die
,
13362 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE
);
13364 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
13365 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type
), context_die
,
13366 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE
);
13368 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
13370 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type
, context_die
);
13373 case FUNCTION_TYPE
:
13374 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
13375 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type
), context_die
,
13376 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE
);
13377 gen_subroutine_type_die (type
, context_die
);
13381 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
13382 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type
), context_die
,
13383 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE
);
13384 gen_subroutine_type_die (type
, context_die
);
13388 gen_array_type_die (type
, context_die
);
13392 gen_array_type_die (type
, context_die
);
13395 case ENUMERAL_TYPE
:
13398 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE
:
13399 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
13400 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
13401 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
13402 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
13403 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
13404 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
13405 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type
)
13406 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type
))
13407 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type
)))
13409 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type
), context_die
, usage
);
13411 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type
))
13414 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
13415 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type
));
13416 context_die
= lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type
));
13421 declare_in_namespace (type
, context_die
);
13425 if (TREE_CODE (type
) == ENUMERAL_TYPE
)
13427 /* This might have been written out by the call to
13428 declare_in_namespace. */
13429 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type
))
13430 gen_enumeration_type_die (type
, context_die
);
13433 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type
, context_die
, usage
);
13438 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
13439 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
13440 when appropriate. */
13446 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE
:
13449 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
13453 /* No Dwarf representation currently defined. */
13457 gcc_unreachable ();
13460 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type
) = 1;
13464 gen_type_die (tree type
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
13466 gen_type_die_with_usage (type
, context_die
, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE
);
13469 /* Generate a DIE for a tagged type instantiation. */
13472 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree type
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
13474 if (type
== NULL_TREE
|| type
== error_mark_node
)
13477 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version of
13478 this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so make sure
13479 that we have the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this
13481 gcc_assert (type
== type_main_variant (type
));
13483 /* Do not check TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) as it may not be set if this is
13484 an instance of an unresolved type. */
13486 switch (TREE_CODE (type
))
13491 case ENUMERAL_TYPE
:
13492 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (type
, context_die
);
13496 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (type
, context_die
);
13500 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE
:
13501 gen_inlined_union_type_die (type
, context_die
);
13505 gcc_unreachable ();
13509 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
13510 things which are local to the given block. */
13513 gen_block_die (tree stmt
, dw_die_ref context_die
, int depth
)
13515 int must_output_die
= 0;
13518 enum tree_code origin_code
;
13520 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
13521 if (stmt
== NULL_TREE
)
13524 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
13525 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
13526 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
13527 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt
))
13531 for (sub
= BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt
); sub
; sub
= BLOCK_CHAIN (sub
))
13532 gen_block_die (sub
, context_die
, depth
+ 1);
13537 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of this block. This block may be an
13538 inlined instance of an inlined instance of inline function, so we have
13539 to trace all of the way back through the origin chain to find out what
13540 sort of node actually served as the original seed for the creation of
13541 the current block. */
13542 origin
= block_ultimate_origin (stmt
);
13543 origin_code
= (origin
!= NULL
) ? TREE_CODE (origin
) : ERROR_MARK
;
13545 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
13547 if (origin_code
== FUNCTION_DECL
)
13548 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
13549 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
13550 must_output_die
= 1;
13553 /* In the case where the current block represents an inlining of the
13554 "body block" of an inline function, we must *NOT* output any DIE for
13555 this block because we have already output a DIE to represent the whole
13556 inlined function scope and the "body block" of any function doesn't
13557 really represent a different scope according to ANSI C rules. So we
13558 check here to make sure that this block does not represent a "body
13559 block inlining" before trying to set the MUST_OUTPUT_DIE flag. */
13560 if (! is_body_block (origin
? origin
: stmt
))
13562 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
13563 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
13564 if (debug_info_level
> DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
)
13565 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
13566 as being a "significant" one. */
13567 must_output_die
= (BLOCK_VARS (stmt
) != NULL
13568 && (TREE_USED (stmt
)
13569 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt
)
13570 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt
)));
13572 /* We are in terse mode, so only local (nested) function
13573 definitions count as "significant" local declarations. */
13574 for (decl
= BLOCK_VARS (stmt
);
13575 decl
!= NULL
; decl
= TREE_CHAIN (decl
))
13576 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == FUNCTION_DECL
13577 && DECL_INITIAL (decl
))
13579 must_output_die
= 1;
13585 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
13586 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
13587 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
13588 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
13589 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
13590 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
13591 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
13592 if (must_output_die
)
13594 if (origin_code
== FUNCTION_DECL
)
13595 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt
, context_die
, depth
);
13597 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt
, context_die
, depth
);
13600 decls_for_scope (stmt
, context_die
, depth
);
13603 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
13604 all of its sub-blocks. */
13607 decls_for_scope (tree stmt
, dw_die_ref context_die
, int depth
)
13612 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
13613 if (stmt
== NULL_TREE
)
13616 if (TREE_USED (stmt
))
13618 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
13619 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
13620 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
13621 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. */
13622 for (decl
= BLOCK_VARS (stmt
); decl
!= NULL
; decl
= TREE_CHAIN (decl
))
13626 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == FUNCTION_DECL
)
13627 die
= lookup_decl_die (decl
);
13628 else if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == TYPE_DECL
&& TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl
))
13629 die
= lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl
));
13633 if (die
!= NULL
&& die
->die_parent
== NULL
)
13634 add_child_die (context_die
, die
);
13635 /* Do not produce debug information for static variables since
13636 these might be optimized out. We are called for these later
13637 in varpool_analyze_pending_decls. */
13638 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == VAR_DECL
&& TREE_STATIC (decl
))
13641 gen_decl_die (decl
, context_die
);
13645 /* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks. */
13646 if (debug_info_level
<= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
)
13649 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
13650 therein) of this block. */
13651 for (subblocks
= BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt
);
13653 subblocks
= BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks
))
13654 gen_block_die (subblocks
, context_die
, depth
+ 1);
13657 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
13660 is_redundant_typedef (const_tree decl
)
13662 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl
))
13665 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl
)
13666 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl
)
13667 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl
))
13668 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl
))) == TYPE_DECL
13669 && DECL_NAME (decl
) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl
))))
13670 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
13676 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
13679 force_decl_die (tree decl
)
13681 dw_die_ref decl_die
;
13682 unsigned saved_external_flag
;
13683 tree save_fn
= NULL_TREE
;
13684 decl_die
= lookup_decl_die (decl
);
13687 dw_die_ref context_die
;
13688 tree decl_context
= DECL_CONTEXT (decl
);
13691 /* Find die that represents this context. */
13692 if (TYPE_P (decl_context
))
13693 context_die
= force_type_die (decl_context
);
13695 context_die
= force_decl_die (decl_context
);
13698 context_die
= comp_unit_die
;
13700 decl_die
= lookup_decl_die (decl
);
13704 switch (TREE_CODE (decl
))
13706 case FUNCTION_DECL
:
13707 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
13708 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
13709 declaration die. */
13710 save_fn
= current_function_decl
;
13711 current_function_decl
= NULL_TREE
;
13712 gen_subprogram_die (decl
, context_die
);
13713 current_function_decl
= save_fn
;
13717 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
13718 gen_decl_die() call. */
13719 saved_external_flag
= DECL_EXTERNAL (decl
);
13720 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl
) = 1;
13721 gen_decl_die (decl
, context_die
);
13722 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl
) = saved_external_flag
;
13725 case NAMESPACE_DECL
:
13726 dwarf2out_decl (decl
);
13730 gcc_unreachable ();
13733 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
13735 decl_die
= lookup_decl_die (decl
);
13736 gcc_assert (decl_die
);
13742 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type. A DIE is
13743 always returned. */
13746 force_type_die (tree type
)
13748 dw_die_ref type_die
;
13750 type_die
= lookup_type_die (type
);
13753 dw_die_ref context_die
;
13754 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type
))
13756 if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type
)))
13757 context_die
= force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type
));
13759 context_die
= force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type
));
13762 context_die
= comp_unit_die
;
13764 type_die
= modified_type_die (type
, TYPE_READONLY (type
),
13765 TYPE_VOLATILE (type
), context_die
);
13766 gcc_assert (type_die
);
13771 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
13772 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
13775 setup_namespace_context (tree thing
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
13777 tree context
= (DECL_P (thing
)
13778 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing
) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing
));
13779 if (context
&& TREE_CODE (context
) == NAMESPACE_DECL
)
13780 /* Force out the namespace. */
13781 context_die
= force_decl_die (context
);
13783 return context_die
;
13786 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
13787 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
13789 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
13790 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope. */
13793 declare_in_namespace (tree thing
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
13795 dw_die_ref ns_context
;
13797 if (debug_info_level
<= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
)
13800 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
13801 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
13802 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
13803 if (DECL_P (thing
) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing
))
13806 ns_context
= setup_namespace_context (thing
, context_die
);
13808 if (ns_context
!= context_die
)
13810 if (DECL_P (thing
))
13811 gen_decl_die (thing
, ns_context
);
13813 gen_type_die (thing
, ns_context
);
13817 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
13820 gen_namespace_die (tree decl
)
13822 dw_die_ref context_die
= setup_namespace_context (decl
, comp_unit_die
);
13824 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
13825 they are an alias of. */
13826 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl
) == NULL
)
13828 /* Output a real namespace. */
13829 dw_die_ref namespace_die
13830 = new_die (DW_TAG_namespace
, context_die
, decl
);
13831 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die
, decl
);
13832 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl
, namespace_die
);
13836 /* Output a namespace alias. */
13838 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
13839 dw_die_ref origin_die
13840 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl
));
13842 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
13843 dw_die_ref namespace_die
13844 = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration
, context_die
, decl
);
13845 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die
, decl
);
13846 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die
, DW_AT_import
, origin_die
);
13847 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl
, namespace_die
);
13851 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL. */
13854 gen_decl_die (tree decl
, dw_die_ref context_die
)
13858 if (DECL_P (decl
) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl
))
13861 switch (TREE_CODE (decl
))
13867 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
13868 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
13871 case FUNCTION_DECL
:
13872 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
13873 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
13874 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl
) == NULL_TREE
&& DECL_CONTEXT (decl
) == NULL_TREE
13875 && (current_function_decl
== NULL_TREE
|| DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl
)))
13880 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
13881 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
13882 if (current_function_decl
!= decl
)
13883 /* This is only a declaration. */;
13886 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
13887 if (DECL_ORIGIN (decl
) != decl
)
13888 dwarf2out_abstract_function (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl
));
13890 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
13891 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
13892 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl
)
13893 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl
)
13894 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die
)
13895 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
13896 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
13897 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
13898 && DECL_INITIAL (decl
) != NULL_TREE
)
13900 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl
);
13901 set_decl_origin_self (decl
);
13904 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
13905 else if (debug_info_level
> DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
)
13907 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
13908 have described its return type. */
13909 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl
)), context_die
);
13911 /* And its virtual context. */
13912 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl
) != NULL_TREE
)
13913 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl
), context_die
);
13915 /* And its containing type. */
13916 origin
= decl_class_context (decl
);
13917 if (origin
!= NULL_TREE
)
13918 gen_type_die_for_member (origin
, decl
, context_die
);
13920 /* And its containing namespace. */
13921 declare_in_namespace (decl
, context_die
);
13924 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
13925 gen_subprogram_die (decl
, context_die
);
13929 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13930 actual typedefs. */
13931 if (debug_info_level
<= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
)
13934 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
13935 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
13936 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
13937 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
13938 have to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
13939 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. */
13940 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl
) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl
) != NULL_TREE
13941 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl
)))
13943 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (TREE_TYPE (decl
), context_die
);
13947 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl
))
13948 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl
), context_die
);
13950 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
13951 gen_typedef_die (decl
, context_die
);
13955 if (debug_info_level
>= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL
)
13956 gen_label_die (decl
, context_die
);
13961 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13962 variable declarations or definitions. */
13963 if (debug_info_level
<= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
)
13966 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
13968 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == RESULT_DECL
&& DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl
))
13969 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl
)), context_die
);
13971 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl
), context_die
);
13973 /* And its containing type. */
13974 origin
= decl_class_context (decl
);
13975 if (origin
!= NULL_TREE
)
13976 gen_type_die_for_member (origin
, decl
, context_die
);
13978 /* And its containing namespace. */
13979 declare_in_namespace (decl
, context_die
);
13981 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
13982 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
13983 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
13985 origin
= decl_ultimate_origin (decl
);
13986 if (origin
!= NULL_TREE
&& TREE_CODE (origin
) == PARM_DECL
)
13987 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl
, context_die
);
13989 gen_variable_die (decl
, context_die
);
13993 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
13994 anonymous unions and structs. */
13995 if (DECL_NAME (decl
) != NULL_TREE
13996 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl
)) == UNION_TYPE
13997 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl
)) == RECORD_TYPE
)
13999 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl
), context_die
);
14000 gen_field_die (decl
, context_die
);
14005 if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl
))
14006 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl
)), context_die
);
14008 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl
), context_die
);
14009 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl
, context_die
);
14012 case NAMESPACE_DECL
:
14013 gen_namespace_die (decl
);
14017 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
14018 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl
) > NUM_TREE_CODES
);
14023 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
14024 compilation proper has finished. */
14027 dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl
)
14029 /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
14030 declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which had no
14031 corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations and
14032 definitions which have not yet been forced out. */
14033 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) != FUNCTION_DECL
|| !DECL_INITIAL (decl
))
14034 dwarf2out_decl (decl
);
14037 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
14038 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
14040 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl
, int local
)
14043 dwarf2out_decl (decl
);
14046 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl. */
14049 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl
, tree context
)
14051 dw_die_ref imported_die
, at_import_die
;
14052 dw_die_ref scope_die
;
14053 expanded_location xloc
;
14055 if (debug_info_level
<= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
)
14060 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
14061 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
14064 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
14065 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
14067 scope_die
= comp_unit_die
;
14068 else if (TYPE_P (context
))
14070 if (!should_emit_struct_debug (context
, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE
))
14072 scope_die
= force_type_die (context
);
14075 scope_die
= force_decl_die (context
);
14077 /* For TYPE_DECL or CONST_DECL, lookup TREE_TYPE. */
14078 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == TYPE_DECL
|| TREE_CODE (decl
) == CONST_DECL
)
14080 if (is_base_type (TREE_TYPE (decl
)))
14081 at_import_die
= base_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl
));
14083 at_import_die
= force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl
));
14087 at_import_die
= lookup_decl_die (decl
);
14088 if (!at_import_die
)
14090 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
14091 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
14092 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == FIELD_DECL
)
14094 tree type
= DECL_CONTEXT (decl
);
14095 dw_die_ref type_context_die
;
14097 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type
))
14098 if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type
)))
14100 if (!should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type
),
14101 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE
))
14103 type_context_die
= force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type
));
14106 type_context_die
= force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type
));
14108 type_context_die
= comp_unit_die
;
14109 gen_type_die_for_member (type
, decl
, type_context_die
);
14111 at_import_die
= force_decl_die (decl
);
14115 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
14116 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == NAMESPACE_DECL
)
14117 imported_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module
, scope_die
, context
);
14119 imported_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration
, scope_die
, context
);
14121 xloc
= expand_location (input_location
);
14122 add_AT_file (imported_die
, DW_AT_decl_file
, lookup_filename (xloc
.file
));
14123 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die
, DW_AT_decl_line
, xloc
.line
);
14124 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die
, DW_AT_import
, at_import_die
);
14127 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
14130 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl
)
14132 dw_die_ref context_die
= comp_unit_die
;
14134 switch (TREE_CODE (decl
))
14139 case FUNCTION_DECL
:
14140 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
14141 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
14142 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
14143 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
14144 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
14145 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
14146 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
14147 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
14148 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
14149 with the definition of the function.
14151 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
14152 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
14153 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
14154 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
14155 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
14156 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
14157 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
14158 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
14159 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
14160 that they *are* definitions).
14162 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
14163 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
14164 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
14165 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
14166 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas. */
14167 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl
) == NULL_TREE
)
14170 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
14171 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
14172 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
14173 if (decl_function_context (decl
)
14174 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
14175 && debug_info_level
> DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
)
14176 context_die
= NULL
;
14180 /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
14181 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
14182 within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
14183 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
14184 which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
14185 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
14186 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
14187 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
14188 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl
) && !TREE_USED (decl
))
14191 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
14192 if (TREE_STATIC (decl
) && decl_function_context (decl
))
14193 context_die
= lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl
));
14195 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
14196 variable declarations or definitions. */
14197 if (debug_info_level
<= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
)
14201 case NAMESPACE_DECL
:
14202 if (debug_info_level
<= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
)
14204 if (lookup_decl_die (decl
) != NULL
)
14209 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
14210 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl
))
14213 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
14214 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
14215 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl
))
14217 /* OK, we need to generate one for `bool' so GDB knows what type
14218 comparisons have. */
14220 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl
)) == BOOLEAN_TYPE
14221 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (decl
))
14222 modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl
), 0, 0, NULL
);
14227 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
14228 if (debug_info_level
<= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
)
14231 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
14232 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
14233 if (decl_function_context (decl
))
14234 context_die
= NULL
;
14242 gen_decl_die (decl
, context_die
);
14245 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
14246 a lexical block. */
14249 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
14250 unsigned int blocknum
)
14252 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
14253 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file
, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
, blocknum
);
14256 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
14260 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
, unsigned int blocknum
)
14262 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
14263 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file
, BLOCK_END_LABEL
, blocknum
);
14266 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
14267 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
14269 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
14270 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
14271 we may end up calling them anyway. */
14274 dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree block
)
14278 for (decl
= BLOCK_VARS (block
); decl
; decl
= TREE_CHAIN (decl
))
14279 if (TREE_CODE (decl
) == FUNCTION_DECL
14280 || (TREE_CODE (decl
) == TYPE_DECL
&& TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl
)))
14286 /* Hash table routines for file_hash. */
14289 file_table_eq (const void *p1_p
, const void *p2_p
)
14291 const struct dwarf_file_data
* p1
= p1_p
;
14292 const char * p2
= p2_p
;
14293 return strcmp (p1
->filename
, p2
) == 0;
14297 file_table_hash (const void *p_p
)
14299 const struct dwarf_file_data
* p
= p_p
;
14300 return htab_hash_string (p
->filename
);
14303 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
14304 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
14305 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
14306 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
14307 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
14308 and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
14309 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
14310 available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
14311 the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
14314 static struct dwarf_file_data
*
14315 lookup_filename (const char *file_name
)
14318 struct dwarf_file_data
* created
;
14320 /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
14321 call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
14322 if (file_table_last_lookup
14323 && (file_name
== file_table_last_lookup
->filename
14324 || strcmp (file_table_last_lookup
->filename
, file_name
) == 0))
14325 return file_table_last_lookup
;
14327 /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table. */
14328 slot
= htab_find_slot_with_hash (file_table
, file_name
,
14329 htab_hash_string (file_name
), INSERT
);
14333 created
= ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct dwarf_file_data
));
14334 created
->filename
= file_name
;
14335 created
->emitted_number
= 0;
14340 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
14341 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
14342 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
14343 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
14344 types, which may include filenames. */
14347 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data
* fd
)
14349 if (! fd
->emitted_number
)
14351 if (last_emitted_file
)
14352 fd
->emitted_number
= last_emitted_file
->emitted_number
+ 1;
14354 fd
->emitted_number
= 1;
14355 last_emitted_file
= fd
;
14357 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
)
14359 fprintf (asm_out_file
, "\t.file %u ", fd
->emitted_number
);
14360 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file
,
14361 remap_debug_filename (fd
->filename
));
14362 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file
);
14366 return fd
->emitted_number
;
14369 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
14370 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
14371 our lookup table. */
14374 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx loc_note
)
14376 char loclabel
[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
];
14377 struct var_loc_node
*newloc
;
14379 static rtx last_insn
;
14380 static const char *last_label
;
14383 if (!DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note
)))
14385 prev_insn
= PREV_INSN (loc_note
);
14387 newloc
= ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct var_loc_node
));
14388 /* If the insn we processed last time is the previous insn
14389 and it is also a var location note, use the label we emitted
14391 if (last_insn
!= NULL_RTX
14392 && last_insn
== prev_insn
14393 && NOTE_P (prev_insn
)
14394 && NOTE_KIND (prev_insn
) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
)
14396 newloc
->label
= last_label
;
14400 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel
, "LVL", loclabel_num
);
14401 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file
, "LVL", loclabel_num
);
14403 newloc
->label
= ggc_strdup (loclabel
);
14405 newloc
->var_loc_note
= loc_note
;
14406 newloc
->next
= NULL
;
14408 if (cfun
&& in_cold_section_p
)
14409 newloc
->section_label
= cfun
->cold_section_label
;
14411 newloc
->section_label
= text_section_label
;
14413 last_insn
= loc_note
;
14414 last_label
= newloc
->label
;
14415 decl
= NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note
);
14416 add_var_loc_to_decl (decl
, newloc
);
14419 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
14420 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
14421 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
14422 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
14425 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun
)
14427 htab_empty (decl_loc_table
);
14429 if (function_section (fun
) != text_section
)
14430 have_multiple_function_sections
= true;
14432 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
14435 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
14436 and record information relating to this source line, in
14437 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
14440 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line
, const char *filename
)
14442 if (debug_info_level
>= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL
14445 int file_num
= maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename
));
14447 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
14449 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
14450 if (flag_debug_asm
)
14451 fprintf (asm_out_file
, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START
,
14454 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
)
14456 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
14457 fprintf (asm_out_file
, "\t.loc %d %d 0\n", file_num
, line
);
14459 /* Indicate that line number info exists. */
14460 line_info_table_in_use
++;
14462 else if (function_section (current_function_decl
) != text_section
)
14464 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
;
14465 targetm
.asm_out
.internal_label (asm_out_file
,
14466 SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
,
14467 separate_line_info_table_in_use
);
14469 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
14470 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
14471 == separate_line_info_table_allocated
)
14473 separate_line_info_table_allocated
+= LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
;
14474 separate_line_info_table
14475 = ggc_realloc (separate_line_info_table
,
14476 separate_line_info_table_allocated
14477 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry
));
14478 memset (separate_line_info_table
14479 + separate_line_info_table_in_use
,
14481 (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
14482 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry
)));
14485 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
14487 = &separate_line_info_table
[separate_line_info_table_in_use
++];
14488 line_info
->dw_file_num
= file_num
;
14489 line_info
->dw_line_num
= line
;
14490 line_info
->function
= current_function_funcdef_no
;
14494 dw_line_info_ref line_info
;
14496 targetm
.asm_out
.internal_label (asm_out_file
, LINE_CODE_LABEL
,
14497 line_info_table_in_use
);
14499 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
14500 if (line_info_table_in_use
== line_info_table_allocated
)
14502 line_info_table_allocated
+= LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
;
14504 = ggc_realloc (line_info_table
,
14505 (line_info_table_allocated
14506 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry
)));
14507 memset (line_info_table
+ line_info_table_in_use
, 0,
14508 LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
* sizeof (dw_line_info_entry
));
14511 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
14512 line_info
= &line_info_table
[line_info_table_in_use
++];
14513 line_info
->dw_file_num
= file_num
;
14514 line_info
->dw_line_num
= line
;
14519 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
14522 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno
, const char *filename
)
14524 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups
)
14526 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
14527 dw_die_ref bincl_die
;
14529 bincl_die
= new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
, comp_unit_die
, NULL
);
14530 add_AT_string (bincl_die
, DW_AT_name
, remap_debug_filename (filename
));
14533 if (debug_info_level
>= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE
)
14535 int file_num
= maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename
));
14537 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section
);
14538 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file
, "Start new file");
14539 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno
, "Included from line number %d",
14542 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num
, "file %s", filename
);
14546 /* Record the end of a source file. */
14549 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
14551 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups
)
14552 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
14553 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
, comp_unit_die
, NULL
);
14555 if (debug_info_level
>= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE
)
14557 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section
);
14558 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file
, "End file");
14562 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
14563 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
14564 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
14567 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
14568 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
14570 if (debug_info_level
>= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE
)
14572 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section
);
14573 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define
, "Define macro");
14574 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno
, "At line number %d", lineno
);
14575 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer
, -1, "The macro");
14579 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
14580 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
14581 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
14584 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
,
14585 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
14587 if (debug_info_level
>= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE
)
14589 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section
);
14590 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef
, "Undefine macro");
14591 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno
, "At line number %d", lineno
);
14592 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer
, -1, "The macro");
14596 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
14599 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
14601 /* Allocate the file_table. */
14602 file_table
= htab_create_ggc (50, file_table_hash
,
14603 file_table_eq
, NULL
);
14605 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
14606 decl_die_table
= htab_create_ggc (10, decl_die_table_hash
,
14607 decl_die_table_eq
, NULL
);
14609 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
14610 decl_loc_table
= htab_create_ggc (10, decl_loc_table_hash
,
14611 decl_loc_table_eq
, NULL
);
14613 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
14614 decl_scope_table
= VEC_alloc (tree
, gc
, 256);
14616 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
14617 abbrev_die_table
= ggc_alloc_cleared (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT
14618 * sizeof (dw_die_ref
));
14619 abbrev_die_table_allocated
= ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT
;
14620 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
14621 abbrev_die_table_in_use
= 1;
14623 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table. */
14624 line_info_table
= ggc_alloc_cleared (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
14625 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry
));
14626 line_info_table_allocated
= LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
;
14628 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
14629 line_info_table_in_use
= 1;
14631 /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors. */
14632 pubname_table
= VEC_alloc (pubname_entry
, gc
, 32);
14633 pubtype_table
= VEC_alloc (pubname_entry
, gc
, 32);
14635 /* Generate the initial DIE for the .debug section. Note that the (string)
14636 value given in the DW_AT_name attribute of the DW_TAG_compile_unit DIE
14637 will (typically) be a relative pathname and that this pathname should be
14638 taken as being relative to the directory from which the compiler was
14639 invoked when the given (base) source file was compiled. We will fill
14640 in this value in dwarf2out_finish. */
14641 comp_unit_die
= gen_compile_unit_die (NULL
);
14643 incomplete_types
= VEC_alloc (tree
, gc
, 64);
14645 used_rtx_array
= VEC_alloc (rtx
, gc
, 32);
14647 debug_info_section
= get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
,
14648 SECTION_DEBUG
, NULL
);
14649 debug_abbrev_section
= get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
,
14650 SECTION_DEBUG
, NULL
);
14651 debug_aranges_section
= get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
,
14652 SECTION_DEBUG
, NULL
);
14653 debug_macinfo_section
= get_section (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
,
14654 SECTION_DEBUG
, NULL
);
14655 debug_line_section
= get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
,
14656 SECTION_DEBUG
, NULL
);
14657 debug_loc_section
= get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
,
14658 SECTION_DEBUG
, NULL
);
14659 debug_pubnames_section
= get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
,
14660 SECTION_DEBUG
, NULL
);
14661 #ifdef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
14662 debug_pubtypes_section
= get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
,
14663 SECTION_DEBUG
, NULL
);
14665 debug_str_section
= get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION
,
14666 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS
, NULL
);
14667 debug_ranges_section
= get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
,
14668 SECTION_DEBUG
, NULL
);
14669 debug_frame_section
= get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
,
14670 SECTION_DEBUG
, NULL
);
14672 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label
, TEXT_END_LABEL
, 0);
14673 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label
,
14674 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
, 0);
14675 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label
, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
, 0);
14676 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label
,
14677 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
, 0);
14678 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label
, COLD_END_LABEL
, 0);
14680 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label
,
14681 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
, 0);
14682 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label
,
14683 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
, 0);
14684 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label
,
14685 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
, 0);
14686 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section
);
14687 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, abbrev_section_label
);
14688 switch_to_section (debug_info_section
);
14689 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, debug_info_section_label
);
14690 switch_to_section (debug_line_section
);
14691 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, debug_line_section_label
);
14693 if (debug_info_level
>= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE
)
14695 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section
);
14696 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label
,
14697 DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
, 0);
14698 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, macinfo_section_label
);
14701 switch_to_section (text_section
);
14702 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, text_section_label
);
14703 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition
)
14705 cold_text_section
= unlikely_text_section ();
14706 switch_to_section (cold_text_section
);
14707 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, cold_text_section_label
);
14711 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
14712 ht_forall. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
14715 output_indirect_string (void **h
, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
)
14717 struct indirect_string_node
*node
= (struct indirect_string_node
*) *h
;
14719 if (node
->form
== DW_FORM_strp
)
14721 switch_to_section (debug_str_section
);
14722 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, node
->label
);
14723 assemble_string (node
->str
, strlen (node
->str
) + 1);
14729 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
14730 /* Verify that all marks are clear. */
14733 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die
)
14737 gcc_assert (! die
->die_mark
);
14738 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die
, c
, verify_marks_clear (c
));
14740 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
14742 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
14743 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
14746 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die
)
14752 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die
, c
, prune_unmark_dies (c
));
14755 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
14756 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
14759 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die
)
14764 for (ix
= 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node
, die
->die_attr
, ix
, a
); ix
++)
14766 if (a
->dw_attr_val
.val_class
== dw_val_class_die_ref
)
14768 /* A reference to another DIE.
14769 Make sure that it will get emitted. */
14770 prune_unused_types_mark (a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_die_ref
.die
, 1);
14772 /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
14773 accounts properly for it. */
14774 if (AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_str
)
14775 a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_str
->refcount
= 0;
14780 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
14781 to DIE's children. */
14784 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die
, int dokids
)
14788 if (die
->die_mark
== 0)
14790 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
14793 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
14794 (But we don't want to mark our parents' kids due to this.) */
14795 if (die
->die_parent
)
14796 prune_unused_types_mark (die
->die_parent
, 0);
14798 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
14799 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die
);
14801 /* If this node is a specification,
14802 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
14803 if (get_AT_flag (die
, DW_AT_declaration
) && die
->die_definition
)
14804 prune_unused_types_mark (die
->die_definition
, 1);
14807 if (dokids
&& die
->die_mark
!= 2)
14809 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
14810 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
14813 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
14814 kids get marked, even if they're types. */
14815 if (die
->die_tag
== DW_TAG_array_type
)
14816 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die
, c
, prune_unused_types_mark (c
, 1));
14818 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die
, c
, prune_unused_types_walk (c
));
14823 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
14826 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die
)
14830 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked. */
14834 switch (die
->die_tag
)
14836 case DW_TAG_const_type
:
14837 case DW_TAG_packed_type
:
14838 case DW_TAG_pointer_type
:
14839 case DW_TAG_reference_type
:
14840 case DW_TAG_volatile_type
:
14841 case DW_TAG_typedef
:
14842 case DW_TAG_array_type
:
14843 case DW_TAG_structure_type
:
14844 case DW_TAG_union_type
:
14845 case DW_TAG_class_type
:
14846 case DW_TAG_interface_type
:
14847 case DW_TAG_friend
:
14848 case DW_TAG_variant_part
:
14849 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type
:
14850 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type
:
14851 case DW_TAG_string_type
:
14852 case DW_TAG_set_type
:
14853 case DW_TAG_subrange_type
:
14854 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type
:
14855 case DW_TAG_file_type
:
14856 if (die
->die_perennial_p
)
14859 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
14863 /* Mark everything else. */
14869 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
14870 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die
);
14872 /* Mark children. */
14873 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die
, c
, prune_unused_types_walk (c
));
14876 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
14880 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die
)
14885 for (ix
= 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node
, die
->die_attr
, ix
, a
); ix
++)
14886 if (AT_class (a
) == dw_val_class_str
)
14888 struct indirect_string_node
*s
= a
->dw_attr_val
.v
.val_str
;
14890 /* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
14891 twice in the hash table. */
14893 == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS
& SECTION_MERGE
) ? 1 : 2))
14896 slot
= htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash
, s
->str
,
14897 htab_hash_string (s
->str
),
14899 gcc_assert (*slot
== NULL
);
14905 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
14908 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die
)
14912 gcc_assert (die
->die_mark
);
14913 prune_unused_types_update_strings (die
);
14915 if (! die
->die_child
)
14918 c
= die
->die_child
;
14920 dw_die_ref prev
= c
;
14921 for (c
= c
->die_sib
; ! c
->die_mark
; c
= c
->die_sib
)
14922 if (c
== die
->die_child
)
14924 /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list. */
14926 /* No marked children at all. */
14927 die
->die_child
= NULL
;
14930 prev
->die_sib
= c
->die_sib
;
14931 die
->die_child
= prev
;
14936 if (c
!= prev
->die_sib
)
14938 prune_unused_types_prune (c
);
14939 } while (c
!= die
->die_child
);
14943 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
14946 prune_unused_types (void)
14949 limbo_die_node
*node
;
14952 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
14953 /* All the marks should already be clear. */
14954 verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die
);
14955 for (node
= limbo_die_list
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
14956 verify_marks_clear (node
->die
);
14957 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
14959 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
14960 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die
);
14961 for (node
= limbo_die_list
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
14962 prune_unused_types_walk (node
->die
);
14964 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the
14965 pubname_table or arange_table. */
14966 for (i
= 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry
, pubname_table
, i
, pub
); i
++)
14967 prune_unused_types_mark (pub
->die
, 1);
14968 for (i
= 0; i
< arange_table_in_use
; i
++)
14969 prune_unused_types_mark (arange_table
[i
], 1);
14971 /* Get rid of nodes that aren't marked; and update the string counts. */
14972 if (debug_str_hash
)
14973 htab_empty (debug_str_hash
);
14974 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die
);
14975 for (node
= limbo_die_list
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
14976 prune_unused_types_prune (node
->die
);
14978 /* Leave the marks clear. */
14979 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die
);
14980 for (node
= limbo_die_list
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
14981 prune_unmark_dies (node
->die
);
14984 /* Set the parameter to true if there are any relative pathnames in
14987 file_table_relative_p (void ** slot
, void *param
)
14990 struct dwarf_file_data
*d
= *slot
;
14991 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (d
->filename
))
14999 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
15000 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
15003 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename
)
15005 limbo_die_node
*node
, *next_node
;
15006 dw_die_ref die
= 0;
15008 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
15009 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
15010 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die
, remap_debug_filename (filename
));
15011 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename
))
15012 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die
);
15013 else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die
, DW_AT_comp_dir
) == NULL
)
15016 htab_traverse (file_table
, file_table_relative_p
, &p
);
15018 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die
);
15021 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
15022 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
15023 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
15024 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
15026 for (node
= limbo_die_list
; node
; node
= next_node
)
15028 next_node
= node
->next
;
15031 if (die
->die_parent
== NULL
)
15033 dw_die_ref origin
= get_AT_ref (die
, DW_AT_abstract_origin
);
15036 add_child_die (origin
->die_parent
, die
);
15037 else if (die
== comp_unit_die
)
15039 else if (errorcount
> 0 || sorrycount
> 0)
15040 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
15041 add_child_die (comp_unit_die
, die
);
15044 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
15045 nested function can be optimized away, which results
15046 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
15047 with the return type of that nested function. Force
15048 this to be a child of the containing function.
15050 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
15051 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
15052 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
15053 the function is likely unreachable too. */
15054 tree context
= NULL_TREE
;
15056 gcc_assert (node
->created_for
);
15058 if (DECL_P (node
->created_for
))
15059 context
= DECL_CONTEXT (node
->created_for
);
15060 else if (TYPE_P (node
->created_for
))
15061 context
= TYPE_CONTEXT (node
->created_for
);
15063 gcc_assert (context
15064 && (TREE_CODE (context
) == FUNCTION_DECL
15065 || TREE_CODE (context
) == NAMESPACE_DECL
));
15067 origin
= lookup_decl_die (context
);
15069 add_child_die (origin
, die
);
15071 add_child_die (comp_unit_die
, die
);
15076 limbo_die_list
= NULL
;
15078 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
15079 emit full debugging info for them. */
15080 retry_incomplete_types ();
15082 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types
)
15083 prune_unused_types ();
15085 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
15086 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
15087 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups
)
15088 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die
);
15090 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
15091 that have children. */
15092 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die
);
15093 for (node
= limbo_die_list
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
15094 add_sibling_attributes (node
->die
);
15096 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
15097 switch_to_section (text_section
);
15098 targetm
.asm_out
.internal_label (asm_out_file
, TEXT_END_LABEL
, 0);
15099 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition
)
15101 switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
15102 targetm
.asm_out
.internal_label (asm_out_file
, COLD_END_LABEL
, 0);
15105 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
15107 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
)
15109 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die
, DW_AT_low_pc
, text_section_label
);
15110 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die
, DW_AT_high_pc
, text_end_label
);
15115 unsigned fde_idx
= 0;
15117 /* We need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
15118 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become
15119 absolute. Historically, we've emitted the unexpected
15120 DW_AT_entry_pc instead of DW_AT_low_pc for this purpose.
15121 Emit both to give time for other tools to adapt. */
15122 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die
, DW_AT_low_pc
, const0_rtx
);
15123 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die
, DW_AT_entry_pc
, const0_rtx
);
15125 add_AT_range_list (comp_unit_die
, DW_AT_ranges
,
15126 add_ranges_by_labels (text_section_label
,
15128 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition
)
15129 add_ranges_by_labels (cold_text_section_label
,
15132 for (fde_idx
= 0; fde_idx
< fde_table_in_use
; fde_idx
++)
15134 dw_fde_ref fde
= &fde_table
[fde_idx
];
15136 if (fde
->dw_fde_switched_sections
)
15138 add_ranges_by_labels (fde
->dw_fde_hot_section_label
,
15139 fde
->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label
);
15140 add_ranges_by_labels (fde
->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label
,
15141 fde
->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label
);
15144 add_ranges_by_labels (fde
->dw_fde_begin
,
15151 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
15152 if (have_location_lists
)
15154 /* Output the location lists info. */
15155 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section
);
15156 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label
,
15157 DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
, 0);
15158 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, loc_section_label
);
15159 output_location_lists (die
);
15162 if (debug_info_level
>= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL
)
15163 add_AT_lineptr (comp_unit_die
, DW_AT_stmt_list
,
15164 debug_line_section_label
);
15166 if (debug_info_level
>= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE
)
15167 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die
, DW_AT_macro_info
, macinfo_section_label
);
15169 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
15170 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
15171 for (node
= limbo_die_list
; node
; node
= node
->next
)
15172 output_comp_unit (node
->die
, 0);
15174 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die
, 0);
15176 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
15177 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section
);
15178 output_abbrev_section ();
15180 /* Output public names table if necessary. */
15181 if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry
, pubname_table
))
15183 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section
);
15184 output_pubnames (pubname_table
);
15187 #ifdef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
15188 /* Output public types table if necessary. */
15189 if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry
, pubtype_table
))
15191 switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section
);
15192 output_pubnames (pubtype_table
);
15196 /* Output the address range information. We only put functions in the arange
15197 table, so don't write it out if we don't have any. */
15198 if (fde_table_in_use
)
15200 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section
);
15204 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
15205 if (ranges_table_in_use
)
15207 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section
);
15208 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file
, ranges_section_label
);
15212 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
15213 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
15214 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
15215 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
15216 examining the file. This is done late so that any filenames
15217 used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'. */
15218 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
)
15220 switch_to_section (debug_line_section
);
15221 output_line_info ();
15224 /* Have to end the macro section. */
15225 if (debug_info_level
>= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE
)
15227 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section
);
15228 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
15231 /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
15233 if (debug_str_hash
)
15234 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash
, output_indirect_string
, NULL
);
15238 /* This should never be used, but its address is needed for comparisons. */
15239 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks
;
15241 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
15243 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"